ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A
Transcription
ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A
Video Product ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A No. D17-7312 Digital Video Camera NTSC Canon Inc. Digital Imaging Products Service Dept. c CANON INC. 2003 First Edition : Feb. 2003 First Print : Feb. 2003 CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION CONTENTS 1. Product Overview ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-1 1-1 Concepts -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-1 1-2 Main Features -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-1 1-2-1 Direct Printer Compatible ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2 1-2-2 DV Messenger -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2 1-3 Function and Performance List ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-3 1-4 Function and Performance Comparison Chart ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-4 2. Technical Explanation ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-10 2-1 Design --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-10 2-1-1 Concept --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-10 2-1-2 Variation -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-10 2-2 DMC III Digital Mechanism Chassis ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11 2-2-1 Improved Quality ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11 2-2-2 Configuration Comparison of DMC II and DMC III ---------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11 2-2-3 DMC III Slide In/Out Status --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-12 2-3 Direct Print (Canon Camera Direct Correspondence Printer) ------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-13 2-3-1 Direct Print Operation Specifications ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-13 2-3-2 Calling Up the Direct Print Setting Screen ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-13 3. Performance and Functions ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-14 4. System Diagram (Common to all Models) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-24 5. Overview of Viewfinder / LCD Panel Displays ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-25 5-1 Camera Mode ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-25 5-2 VCR Mode ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-32 5-3 Card/Camera Mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-36 5-4 Card Playback Mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) ------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-39 5-5 Menu Display ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-41 5-6 Card-Related Screen Displays ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-52 5-7 Direct Print Setting Screen ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-60 5-8 Print ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-63 5-9 Warning Displays --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-64 6. Backing Up Various Data ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-66 6-1 Backup by Main Power Supply ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-66 6-2 Backup by Main Power Supply or Backup Power Supply (Lithium Coin Primary Battery) ------------------------------ 1-66 6-3 Backup Conditions Related to Switch Operation -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-67 6-3-1 Turning OFF the Power -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-67 6-3-2 Switching the Power Switch to a Different Position ----------------------------------------------------------------- 1-68 6-3-3 Switching Camera Modes/Switching Program AE Modes ---------------------------------------------------------- 1-69 7. Other Features -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-70 7-1 Green Mode --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-70 7-2 On Screen ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-70 7-3 Headphones and Speaker ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-71 7-4 Battery Indicator, Low-Power Warning, and Low-Power Shutoff ------------------------------------------------------------- 1-71 7-5 System Data Displays ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-71 7-6 Data Code Display ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-71 7-7 MP Tape Support --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-71 7-8 Confirmation Beep ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-72 7-9 Using Analog Line Recording and DV Recording ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-73 7-10 Support for Analog Signal I/O Copyright Protection Signals ---------------------------------------------------------------- 1-74 7-11 Video ID1 Detection/Output Support -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-74 7-12 Audio Dubbing ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-75 7-12-1 Tapes to which Audio Dubbing can be Added ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-75 7-12-2 Selecting an Audio Dubbing Signal Input Source ------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-75 7-12-3 Audio Dubbing Procedure ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-75 7-12-4 CGMS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-75 7-13 AV Insert (Not available on PAL Models) --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-76 7-13-1 Tapes Allowing AV Insert ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-76 7-13-2 AV Insert Signal Input Source Selection ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-76 7-13-3 AV Insert Procedure ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-76 7-13-4 CGMS --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-76 7-14 Analog/Digital Signal Conversion ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-77 7-14-1 A/D Signal Conversion Pocedure ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-77 7-14-2 CGMS --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-77 7-15 Multi Switch ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-77 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 1. Product Overview 1-1 Concepts Multi Media Compact & Stylish Camcorder The ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A is more stylish than the ZR50 MC A, ZR45 MC A, ZR47 MC KR, ZR40 A and delivers functions to rival multimedia models. ◆ Benefits from efforts to reform the cost structure of the Canon lineup. ◆ Deluxe, more stylish design. ◆ Retains the superb performance of the ZR50 MC A, ZR45 MC A, ZR47 MC KR, ZR40 A series while adding multimedia features. ◆ More advanced picture quality than the ZR50 MC A, ZR45 MC A, ZR47 MC KR, ZR40 A. ◆ Available in three separate models to meet a range of user requirements. 1-2 Main Features (1) Compact & Stylish ● New Stylish Design (2) High Performance Lens ● 22× optical zoom lens compatible with 1/ 6- inch CCD (ZR70 MC A only) (3) Excellent Picture Quality ● MACS system for improved picture quality (4) Multimedia ● Memory card slot, USB terminal (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) ● Motion- JPEG (ZR70 MC A only) Camera Direct ● Camera Direct (5) Advanced Specification ● Advanced accessory shoe (ZR70 MC A only) ● New Digital Feature (6) All In One ● 2.5- inch LCD and CVF, terminals on camera body 1-1 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 1-2-1 Direct Printer Compatible Easy to connect and easy to print ◆ Printing XGA still images stored on a memory card is simple. ZR70 MC, ZR65 MC XGA-size (1024 × 768) still images Direct Printer Camera Direct Printer (BJ F890PD) (BJ 895PD) (BJ 535PD) Control printer from DVC Printer cable 1-2-2 DV Messenger A peer-to-peer type bidirectional communications software program for linking digital video camcorders and PCs. ◆ Allows bidirectional sending of audio or video content and messages (text or images) via the Internet. ◆ Basic specifications are compatible with Windows Messenger. ◆ Allows control (camera zoom and focus, VCR playback and stop, access to the memory card) of the digital video camcorder from a remote PC. IEEE1394 Internet IEEE1394 1-2 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 1-3 Function and Performance List Specifications ZR70 MC A Zoom mag. ZR65 MC A 22× optical zoom/ 20× optical zoom/ 18× optical zoom/ 440× digital zoom*1 400× digital zoom*1 360× digital zoom*1 CCD 1/6-inch interlaced CCD (total pixels : 680,000) Image stabilization Electronic image stabilizer (motion video effective pixels : 340,000) Monitor 2.5-inch screen, 112,000 pixels LCD monitor EVF 0.33-inch screen, 113,000 pixel color viewfinder ● ● *2 ● (SD memory card, MultiMediaCard) × Analog line input Memory card function Card Still images Progressive Photo recording Card motion video ZR60 A × (1024×768, 640×480) Motion JPEG + audio recording × (monaural) × USB file transfer ● × USB direct print ● × IEEE1394 file ● transfer IEEE1394 streaming ● video ● USB compatible × ● (Compatible with Accessory shoe ● advanced accessory shoe) Auxiliary illumination function White LED (Super Night mode: tape) × (Low light + time: card) ● (6 colors) × ● (Super Night mode) ● ● × BP-512 BP-508 Illuminated keys Night mode Wide attachment lens *1 : Tape mode only *2 : Not applicable to PAL models 1-3 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 1-4 Function and Performance Comparison Chart Item ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Camera Image sensing Image size device 1/6-inch CCD Card 1/6-inch System (filter) Interlacing (color correction filters) Total pixels 680,000 pixels Effective pixels Lens Tape Optical zoom Tape 340,000 pixels Card 447,000 pixels Tape magnification, ZR70 MC A : 22× 2.8 - 61.6 mm (approx. 54 - 1,188 mm) ZR65 MC A : 20× 2.8 - 56 mm (approx. 54 - 1,080 mm) focal length ZR60 A (35mm equivalent) : 18× 2.8 - 50.4 mm (approx. 54 - 972 mm) Card ZR70 MC A : 22× 2.8 - 61.6 mm (approx. 48 - 1,056 mm) Tape ZR70 MC A : 88× /440× 246.4 mm / 1,232 mm ZR65 MC A : 20× 2.8 - 56 mm (approx. 48 - 960 mm) Digital zoom magnification Magnification,focal length (35mm equivalent) (equivalent to approx. 4,752 mm / 23,760 mm) ZR65 MC A : 80× /400× 224 mm / 1,120 mm (equivalent to approx. 4,320 mm / 21,600 mm) ZR 60 A : 72× /360× 201.6 mm / 1,008 mm (equivalent to approx. 3,888 mm / 19,440 mm) System Noise reduction Card None Tape CCD readout Card ----- F number ZR70 MC A : F1.6 - 3.6, ZR65 MC A : F1.6 - 3.2, ZR60 A : F1.6 - 2.9 Aperture blades 2 Zoom speed Variable Filter diameter 30.5mm P0.5 Camera Tape Card Either CCD-NR or Y/C-NR Motion video Still images None Chroma-only, median filter Recorder C-NR Minimum Night mode 1.6 lx illumination Low Light mode 3.4 lx Auto mode Image stabilization 14 lx Adjustment Tape system Card Sensing method Electronic None Angular velocity sensing Shooting functions AE mode Program AE Tape (Full Auto) (Auto, Sports, Portrait, Spotlight, Surf & Snow, Low Light, Night, Super Night (ZR70 MC A only)) Card (Full Auto) (Auto, Sports, Portrait, Spotlight, Surf & Snow, Low Light, Low Light+ (ZR70 MC A only)) Photometric Center-bottom-weighted average system Full Auto, Auto, Sports, Portrait, Low Light, Night, Super Night (ZR70 MC A only) Evaluative photometry + 128 segments (Spotlight mode, Surf & Snow mode (Sand & Snow mode)) All area photometry 1-4 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Item ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Shooting functions Exposure AE lock × adjustment AE shift Supported (after pressing Setting key, adjust using Multi-switch and press Setting key again) ± 2 steps (Disabled during Green mode, Spotlight mode, Surf & Snow mode, Night mode, and Super Night mode) Shutter speed Exposure correction × Gain setting/sensitivity increase Auto Back light correction × High-speed shutter Tape 6 levels (1/60, 1/100, 1/250, 1/500, 1/1000, 1/2000, second. (Auto mode)) Auto Card Switches upper limit to 1/250 second (included Program AE) Tape 1/60 sec - 1/500 sec. Card Slow shutter 1/30 sec - 1/250 sec. 1/15 sec (Low Light mode, Low Light +), 1/8 sec to 1/60 sec (Night mode, Super Night mode) Aperture value Auto iris Image quality Color gain adjustment × adjustment Hue adjustment × (custom preset) Sharpness adjustment × Setup adjustment × White Balance Focus Auto ● Preset Outdoor, Indoor System TTL, 128 segments Mode AF/MF, forced infinity Manual focus 16:9 Multi-switch operation Recording system Tape Vertical Stretching Card × × Area marker display Digital fade Tape Motion video Auto Fade, Wipe, Corner Wipe, Jump, Flip, Puzzle, Zigzag, Beam, Tide (executed by pressing the Start/Stop button.) Card Still Image × Motion video × Still Image × Digital effect Tape Motion video/still Image Art, Black & White, Sepia, Mosaic, Ball, Cube, Wave, Color Mask, Mirror Card Motion video/still Image Black & White Card mix Tape Motion video/still Image Card Lumi key, Card Chroma key, Camera Chroma key, Animation Card Motion video/still Image × Multi-screen Tape Motion video/still Image Supported (disabled in Night mode and Super Night mode) Card Motion video/still Image × Capture speed 1/60 sec. Manual, Fast (every 4th field), Normal (every 6th field), Shutter speed Slow (every 8 fields) 1/15 sec. Manual, Fast (every 4 fields), Normal (every 8 fields), Shutter speed Slow (every 12 fields) Tape Normal Card 320 × 240 pixels (continuous, approx. 10 seconds), 160 × 120 pixels (ZR70 MC A only) (continuous, approx. 30 seconds) Motion video shooting Mode 1-5 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Item ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Shooting functions Still image Mode Tape Normal (field) Card Progressive (iris shutter) (disabled in Night mode) Tape 6.5 sec. recording time Card × Continuous Tape × shooting Card × Photo button Form Still image only button Single image Half depressed Supported (recording standby only) Still image confirmation Only with card mounted Strobe support (models) × Recorded image Frame image (video output is field image) Frame processing Pseudo frame (Low Light mode, Night mode, Super Night (Slow) mode) Negative-positive reversal × Video light × (For only ZR70 MC A, white LED is provided (turned ON in super-night mode, low-light mode)) Zebra pattern × Color bar display × Selftimer 10 sec./remote control: 2 sec. Interval timer × Clear scan × Recorded image size/file format VGA: 640(H) × 480 (V), XGA: 1024(H) × 768(V)/JPEG (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Memory card SD memory card, MultiMediaCard REC search ● REC review ● Standby switch × Power save (after 5 minutes in Recording pause) Power shutoff Displayed text recording × Audio 16-bit 2-channel (48KHz) 12-bit 4-channel (32 kHz) Simultaneous 4-channel recording not possible ● ON/OFF switch (built-in microphone only) Wind screen EVF Monitor LCD Size 0.33-inch (TFT color RGB delta arrangement) Pixels 113,000 Brightness adjustment × Color adjustment × Movable × Size 2.5-inch Pixels 112,000 Brightness adjustment ● Movable ● Supports mirror shooting 1-6 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Item ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A VCR Playback Frame playback system Slow playback Forward/Reverse 2X SP playback Forward/Reverse 1X SP playback Forward/Reverse Cue/review 9.5X speed Search Forward/Reverse Photo search ● Date search ● Index search × ● (Tape playback or card still image playback) Special playback Playback zoom (2X zoom) effects D. effects D. fade Multi screen Data code display Card Tape Art, Black & White, Sepia, Mosaic, Ball, Cube, Wave, Color Mask, Mirror Card × Tape Auto fade, Wipe, Corner wipe, Jump, Flip, Puzzle, Zig Zag, Beam, Tide Card × 4/9/16 screen (tape only) Time and Date display Slide show ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Index playback ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) (6-screen playback) Card fast forward/rewind ● Audio dubbing AV insert Digital ● Analog ● ● Zero set memory Edit function Card jump (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Simple editing × Special effects × 1-7 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Item ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A System ● Inter face Microphone input (terminal) Headphone output ● DV terminal Input/output S terminal Input/output AV terminal Input/output, φ3.5mm jack (also serves as headphone terminal) Editing terminal (LANC terminal) × USB port (mini-B Receptacle) ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Memory card file transfer ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) DV to Analog signal conversion ● Direct print ● (When connected to BJ 535PD or BJ 895PD camera direct printer: ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Border yes/no and number of copies can be set (DPOF compatible) World clock ● Text titles × Speaker ● Confirmation beep ● Tally light × 1 and 2, Remote control cord Supports Accessory shoe ● (ZR70 MC A only; supports advanced accessory shoe) Video ID ● (ID2) Recording modes SP,LP Illuminated keys ● (6 colors: ZR70 MC A only) Custom key × Index Screen key ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Card mix key ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Slideshow key ● (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) DV control × Internal battery charging ● Backup power Lithium coin battery (CR1616) Battery pack power BP-500 series lithium ion battery 1-8 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT ● External View Fig. 1-1 1-9 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 2. Technical Explanation 2-1 Design 2-1-1 Concept The design of the ZR50 MC A, ZR45 MC A, ZR47 MC KR, ZR40 A has been further refined with the introduction of a more streamlined surface. The popular layout of the ZR50 MC A, ZR45 MC A, ZR47 MC KR, ZR40 A has been retained. The MENU buttons have been moved out of the LCD to improve ease of use. Independently illuminated keys are used (ZR70 MC A) and the feel of the colored clear keys enhanced (both ZR65 MC A and ZR60 A). The front terminal cover is now finished with metallic paint on all models (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, and ZR60 A) for a more deluxe look. 2-1-2 Variation ZR70 MC A Illuminated keys (with white LEDs) (22x zoom) Champagne metallic (same as ZR50 MC A) Cover L: Silver (paint) EVF: Silver (paint) ZR65 MC A Blue clear keys EVF: Silver (paint) (20x zoom) ZR 60 A Blue clear keys EVF: Gray (color of molded plastic) (18x zoom) Blue metallic (same as ELURA40 MC A) Dark blue metallic (new color) Cover L: Gray (color of molded plastic) Cover L: Gray (color of molded plastic) 1-10 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 2-2 DMC III Digital Mechanism Chassis 2-2-1 Improved Quality The DMC I and DMC II digital mechanism chassis, which formed the core of previous Canon camcorder models, were developed in 1997 and 1999, respectively. They helped make those camcorders more compact. In particular, as the excellent image quality and reliability of Canon camcorders has come to be highly evaluated by the marketplace in recent years, the number of units manufactured has been increasing substantially. The DMC III digital mechanism chassis was developed with the aims of further improving reliability, by drastically reducing the number of component parts, and also enhancing quality. At the same times, the developers worked to reduce the cassette loading time and improve ease of operation. Digital mechanism chassis period Drum diameter DMC III DMC II October 2002 January 2000 21.7mm 21.7mm ● ● 56mm 56mm Slide Size Depth Width 72mm 72mm Height 23.7mm 22.2mm Volume 95cc 89cc Weight 100g 100g Number of parts 194 272 FF/REW speed 30x 30x 2-2-2 Configuration Comparison of DMC II and DMC III DMC III DMC II 72mm 56mm 22.2mm 23.7mm 72mm 56mm 1-11 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 2-2-3 DMC III Slide In/Out Status Slide out status 23.7mm 39.4mm Slide in status 56mm 73mm 1-12 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 2-3 Direct Print (Canon Camera Direct Correspondence Printer) By connecting the Canon BJ F890PD or BJ 895PD or BJ 535PD camera direct correspondence printer to the product (ZR70 MC A), the user can print still images stored on an SD memory card or MultiMediaCard without using a PC. Note: This function is not compatible with the CP-100 or CP-10 card photo printer. 2-3-1 Direct Print Operation Specifications Compatible printers BJ F890PD/BJ 895PD/BJ 535PD Functions 1 image ● Partial image × Border yes/no ● Date yes/no × Number of copies ● DPOF specified printing ● Index printing × Trimming × Operation keys Change button focus Multi switch (up-down) Confirmation button Setting button Card image advance Card image advance + and - buttons 2-3-2 Calling Up the Direct Print Setting Screen (1) The camcorder must be in the Card Playback mode with the BJ 895PD connected and the BJ 895PD powered on. In the upper left-hand corner of the screen two icons marked Print and Settings are displayed. If a memory card with images stored on it is mounted in the camcorder, the last image recorded is displayed on the screen. (2) Press the Setting switch. The camcorder switches to the Direct Print mode. Turn the Multi switch to select Print, Cancel, No. of Copies, or Style (Border or No Border) and specify the setting for the desired item. (Refer to page 60 for details of the screen.) L Size Borderless The direct print setting specifications are basically the same as those for a digital Style camera. However, the card image advance item on the setting screen is unique to video cameras, and the Advance button works at all times except when an image displayed in reduced size is in the process of being printed. Copies OK Cancel Other (1) The image larger than 160 × 120 dots and smaller than 2024 × 1536 dots can be printed. However, the file larger than 2MB cannot be printed. (2) Animation image cannot be printed. 1-13 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 3. Performance and Functions 1 Type 2 Recording system 2-1 Video signal recording system Quantized bits 2-2 Audio signal recording system 2-3 Tracking 2-4 Tape speed 2-5 Head drum Drum diameter Rpms Heads ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A VTR- integrated camera Rotating two- head helical scan azimuth recording Consumer electronics digital DVC (SD specs) Complies with NTSC system (525 lines, 60 fields) Digital component recording. R-Y, B-Y = 3.375MHz 8bits PCM digital recording. 16-bit, 48KHz 2 ch (Stereo 1) 12-bit, 32KHz 4 ch (Stereo 1 and 2) 2-frequency pilot system Approx. 18.81mm/second. (in SP mode) Approx. 12.56mm/second. (in LP mode) φ 21.7mm 9000/ 1.001 rotations/ minute Video heads: 2 3 Recording/ playback time 80 minutes maximum (in SP mode) 120 minutes maximum (in LP mode) Continuous recording time using battery/ actual recording time ZR70 MC A BP-508 Approx. --- minutes/ --- minutes (using CVF), BP-512 Approx. 180 minutes/ 95 minutes (using CVF), BP-522 Approx. 370 minutes/195 minutes (using CVF), BP-535 Approx. 590 minutes/315 minutes (using CVF), ZR65 MC A BP-508 Approx. 100 minutes/ 55 minutes (using CVF), BP-512 Approx. 180 minutes/ 95 minutes (using CVF), BP-522 Approx. 370 minutes/195 minutes (using CVF), BP-535 Approx. 590 minutes/315 minutes (using CVF), ZR60 A BP-508 Approx. 100 minutes/ 55 minutes (using CVF), BP-512 Approx. 180 minutes/ 95 minutes (using CVF), BP-522 Approx. 370 minutes/195 minutes (using CVF), BP-535 Approx. 590 minutes/315 minutes (using CVF), 4 Cassette tape specifications Mini DVC specs 4-1 Tape type Vapor- deposited metal tape 4-2 Tape width 6.35mm Vapor- deposited metal tape 4-3 Tape thickness 7µm 5 Camera 5-1 Image sensing device 1/ 6- inch interlaced CCD 5-1-1 Pixels Total pixels Approx. 680,000 Actual effective pixels Approx. 340,000 (tape) Approx. 447,000 (card) 5-1-2 Filter Color correction filter 5-1-3 Color separation system Differential read out 5-1-4 Signal configuration NTSC standard color TV signal 5-1-5 Scanning system 525 lines × 60 fields / 30 frames 5-1-6 Minimum subject illumination Auto mode Approx. 14 lx Low light mode Approx. 3.4 lx Night mode Approx. 1.6 lx 5-1-7 Subject illumination range Approx. 1.6 lx to approx. 100,000 lx 1-14 Approx. --- minutes/ --- minutes (using LCD) Approx. 140 minutes/ 75 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 295 minutes/155 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 470 minutes/250 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 75 minutes/ 40 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 140 minutes/ 75 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 295 minutes/155 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 470 minutes/250 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 75 minutes/ 40 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 140 minutes/ 75 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 295 minutes/155 minutes (using LCD) Approx. 470 minutes/250 minutes (using LCD) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-2 Photo lens 5-2-1 Nominal focal length Tape recording ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A Card recording ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 5-2-2 Nominal aperture ratio ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 5-2-3 Lens configuration 5-2-4 Focus adjustment 5-2-5 Minimum object distance 5-2-6 Power zoom Using optical zoom Using electronic zoom 5-2-7 Focal length display 5-2-8 Macro mechanism 5-2-9 Macro shooting distance 5-2-10 Filter diameter 5-2-11 Accessory lens, filter 5-2-12 Lens hood 5-2-13 Lens cap 5-3 Digital zoom (tape recording only) ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 5-4 Image stabilization function 5-4-1 System 5-4-2 Shaking sensing system 5-5 Shooting modes 5-5-1 Tape shooting mode Photo mode 2.8 to 61.6 mm 22x zoom (35 mm equivalent: 54 to 1,188 mm) 2.8 to 56 mm 20x zoom (35 mm equivalent: 54 to 1, 080 mm) 2.8 to 50.4 mm 18x zoom (35 mm equivalent: 54 to 972 mm) 2.8 to 61.6 mm 22x zoom (35 mm equivalent: 48 to 1,056 mm) 2. 8 to 56 mm 20x zoom (35 mm equivalent: 48 to 960 mm) ——— (Card recording not supported) 1 : 1.6 (F3.6 on tele end) 1 : 1.6 (F3.2 on tele end) 1 : 1.6 (F2.9 on tele end) 11 elements in 8 groups, using one two- sided aspheric lens Inner focus type, manually adjustable (adjusted by rotating multi- dial) 10 mm (AF linked; wide end), 1 m for full zoom area (from lens tip) Multi- level variable- speed power zoom, slide lever system. The zoom speed can be changed depending on the shift amount of the slide lever. Approx. 2.1 seconds to approx. 23 seconds (Using tape) Approx. 1.9 seconds to approx. 20 seconds (Using card) Approx. 3.6 seconds to approx. 26 seconds (Using tape) Approx. 2.5 seconds to approx. 22 seconds (Using card) Manual zooming cannot be used (no zoom ring) None. There is a simple zoom display in the viewfinder. Wide end macro 10 mm (from lens front) 30.5 mm P0.5 Can use WD- 30.5, TL- 30.6, FS- 30.5U, or WA- 30.5 (WA- 30.5 is supplied with ZR70 MC A model only.) None Included; Screw-on type To 88x (approx. 246.4 mm (35 mm equivalent: 4,752 mm)), to 440x (approx. 1,232 mm (35 mm equivalent: 23,760 mm)) To 80x (approx. 224 mm (35 mm equivalent: 4,320 mm)), to 400x (approx. 1,120 mm (35 mm equivalent: 21,600 mm)) To 72x (approx. 201.6 mm (35 mm equivalent: 3,888 mm)), to 360x (approx. 1,008 mm (35 mm equivalent: 19,440 mm)) Included (using tape only) Electronic image stabilizer Angular velocity sensing (using piezoelectric vibration sensor) Motion Video mode, Photo mode (tape and card recording (card recording on ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only)) Normal motion video mode (Start and Stop button operation: interlaced scanning) or still image mode (Photo button operation: field still) Still image recording (frame recording; field recording during Card Mix in motion video mode) for approx. 6.5 seconds Half- push lock display ( ) for photo button in viewfinder: Displayed in green when AF is locked. 5-5-2 Card recording (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) When the Photo button is operated in Card Recording mode, Progressive Photo images can be saved as still images onto a MultiMedia Card or SD (Secure Digital) memory card. Motion video and audio can be recorded on memory card by operating Start/ Stop button (ZR70 MC A only). Recording format DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) compliant Image compression format JPEG format (Motion JPEG for motion video), switchable compression ratio (irreversible) (Super Fine, Fine, Standard), refer to section on memory card system (page 1-20) 1-15 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-6 Exposure control 5-6-1 AE function Program AE 5-6-2 Photometric system Screen segments 5-6-3 Exposure correction function AE shift AE Shift amount 5-6-4 Electronic shutter High-speed shutter Low-speed shutter 5-7 AF (Autofocus) 5-7-1 System 5-7-2 AF range finding area 5-7-3 Range finding window display 5-7-4 AF operating range 5-7-5 AF operating illumination range 5-7-6 AF mode switching Manual focus Infinity focus 5-8 Viewfinder 5-8-1 5-8-2 5-8-3 5-8-4 Rotation Removal of eyepiece Diopter movement range Lens configuration Full Auto mode, Auto mode, Sports mode, Portrait mode, Spotlight mode, Surf (Sand) & Snow mode, Low Light mode, Low Light + mode (ZR70 MC A: Card and Camera modes only), Night mode, Super Night mode (Super Night mode is ZR70 MC A only) Center- bottom- weighted average : Full Auto mode, Auto mode, Sports mode, Portrait mode, Low Light mode, Low Light + mode (ZR70 MC A: Card and Camera modes only), Night mode, Super Night mode (ZR70 MC A only) Whole area average photometry + 128- segment evaluative photometry : Spotlight mode, Surf (Sand) & Snow mode 128 segments (16H × 8V) AE shift is performed by pressing the AE Shift button. After AE shift, the AE level can be corrected using the multi- dial (except in Full Auto mode, Spotlight mode, Surf & Snow mode (Sand & Snow mode), Night mode or Super Night mode). ± 7 levels( –2.0, –1.5, –1.25, –1.0, –0. 75, –0.5, –0. 25, ±0, +0.25, +0.5, +0.75, +1.0, +1.25, +1.5, +2.0). Indicated by a number (AE ± 0) in the viewfinder. 1/ 60 second, 1/ 100 second, 1/ 250 second, 1/ 500 second, 1/ 1000 second, 1/ 2000 second (can be selected in Auto mode) Up to 1/ 250 second in Card mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A models) When image stabilizer is ON: 1/ 100 second (flickering sensed) 1/ 120 second (flickering not sensed) When image stabilizer is OFF: 1/ 100 second (flickering sensed) 1/ 15 second (Low Light mode, Low Light + mode: constant speed) 1/ 60 second to 1/ 8 second (Night mode, Super Night mode) (1/ 8 second to 1/ 500 second automatic setting in Night mode and Super Night mode (ZR70 MC A only)) TTL–video signal sensing AF Screen center None. 10 mm to infinite (at wide end); 1 m to infinite in full zoom area (from lens front) 50 lx - 100,000 lx Continuous AF/ manual focus/ infinity focus. AF can be turned ON/ OFF (by pressing Focus button) except in Full Auto mode. During manual focus (AF OFF), the (MF) display appears in the viewfinder. The shooting distance can be forced to infinity by holding down the ∞ side of the Multi- switch in the manual focus mode. 0.33- inch screen, color LCD (approx. 113,000 pixels), ON when LCD monitor is closed (panel facing inwards) and during mirror shooting Possible (70° upward to support low- angle shooting) Possible +1.0 to –5.0 diopter (when eye is at eyepiece) Two elements in two groups 1-16 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-9 LCD panel 2.5- inch screen, color LCD, approx. 112,000 pixels (480 (H) × 234 (V)) TFT active matrix drive. RGB delta arrangement; ON except when monitor is closed (panel facing inwards) 5-9-1 Angle adjustment Possible; monitoring is possible for high- angle, low- angle, and during mirror shooting. 5-9-2 Information display Color display of operating mode, simple zoom position, remaining battery charge, remaining tape, data code, warnings and other indications. Information display is not provided during mirror shooting. Relationship between LCD monitor and viewfinder (CVF) Camera mode and Card/Camera mode LCD panel position VCR mode/Card Playback mode LCD panel CVF LCD panel CVF OFF ON OFF ON Panel closed (panel facing inwards) Panel closed (panel facing outwards) ON OFF ON OFF Panel open ON OFF ON OFF ON ON OFF Mirror shooting *3 ON *2 *1 : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only *2 : Can be set to Mirror mode through menu selection. *3 : During Mirror mode, the screen display is flipped left- right (AE shift, window screen, 16:9, card mix, fader, effect, shutter speed, date and time display) or does not appear ( / card image quality, and recording size only). Card Recording mode: No card , Card Present and Access Indicator <<<< (Mirror mode is temporarily turned off during REC search and when a warning is displayed.) 5-10 White balance adjustment TTL 128 segments, new white extraction system FAWB; includes set/ preset (outdoor: 5,600 k; indoor: 3,200 k) (selected through camera menu) Adjustment range 5-11 Digital feature functions 2,800 k to 8,000 k The following modes are provided: Fader, Effects, Multi-screen. Fader : Can be executed once when Fade mode is displayed in conjunction with pressing the Start/Stop button (the mode display disappears when Fader ends). Effects : Effects are sustained until this function is turned off. Multi-screen : A number of images, equal to the number of screen windows, are captured and displayed manually or each time a fixed number of seconds passes. The display remains until this function is turned off. Card mix : A mixture of included sample images, images recorded to a card, and camera motion video is displayed. (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model only) 5-11-1 Fader (tape recording only) Audio synchronized fader Auto fade (JAPAN models: White Fade; Overseas models: Black Fade), Wipe, Corner Wipe, Jump, Flip, Puzzle, Zigzag, Beam, Tide. Fade time Approx. 4 seconds. 5-11-2 Effects Art, Black and White, Sepia, Mosaic, Ball, Cube, Wave, Color Mask, Mirror (Black and White only in card recording mode). The effects function is toggled ON/OFF by pressing the D. Effect button. 5-11-3 Multi-screen (tape recording only; excludes Night mode) Number of screens 4 (2 × 2), 9 (3 × 3), 16 (4 × 4) Operating modes Manual, Fast (every 4 frames), Normal (every 6 frames), Slow (every 8 frames) During Low Light mode, the settings are Fast (every 4 frames), Normal (every 8 frames), and Slow (every 12 frames) 5-11-4 Card Mix (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Mix type Mix type Card Chroma key, Card Lumi. key, Camera Chroma key (iPAL model not equipped with Camera Chroma key) Mix level adjustment Adjustable, 32 levels 5-11-5 Availability in operation modes Camera Card (still image) Card (motion video) Tape (still image) Fader × × × Effect Black and White only Black and White only Multi-screen × × Card Mix × × 1-17 Tape (motion video) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-12 Built-in microphone 5-12-1 Wind screen function 5-13 Other additional functions 5-13-1 Time code 5-13-2 Data code Time and date Camera data 5-13-3 Accessory shoe 5-13-4 REC Search mechanism 5-13-5 REC Review function Stereo (using electret condenser microphone) Stereo provided by 2 nondirectional microphones and electric circuit Provided, with ON/OFF switch (selected by menu; built-in microphone only) Time code Displays recording time (0:00:00 to 7:59:59) and records in sub-code area. Though not displayed during recording, the date and camera information during recording are automatically recorded and can be displayed during playback. Automatic calendar range: January 1, 2003 through December 31, 2030 (the initial setting is January 1, 2003) World clock capability (select the name of your destination city and the date and time are automatically adjusted to the local date and time); supports daylight savings time. During playback, time can be displayed in three different modes (date only, time and date, or time only). (Time and date can be displayed for January 1, 1990 through December 31, 2089.) Shutter speed and aperture value information are recorded (but not displayed during recording), and can be displayed during playback. Included (advanced accessory shoe: ZR70 MC A only). Included. Tape can be played (forward or reverse) by pressing the REC Search button while camera recording is paused. (When REC Search ends, the camera recording is paused again.) Included. Accessed by operating the Recording Check button when camera recording is paused. 5-13-6 Zero Set Memory Included. This function allows you to rewind or fast- forward the tape to the position where the WL- D79/ WL- D80 Zero Set Memory key is pressed (the counter value is set to 0: 00: 00). (During recording, only zero setting is allowed. This function can be used in Playback mode.) 5-13-7 Remote control reception ON/ OFF Possible. This can be done in Camera mode and VCR mode (through menu selection). 5-13-8 Headphone volume adjustment Possible. Can be adjusted using the multi- switch. 6 Recorder 6-1 Recording functions 6-1-1 Recording format 6-1-2 Tape speed SD spec 6-1-3 DV input recording 6-2 6-3 6-4 6-5 Camera shooting and recording, DV input recording, analog input recording Consumer electronics digital DVC (SD specs) Approx. 18.81 mm/ second (in SP mode) , Approx. 12.56 mm/ second (in LP mode) Complies with IEEE1394. Records video/ audio signals from a digital video camera connected through a DV cable. 6-1-4 Analog input recording Records analog video/ audio signals using an S Video terminal and AV terminal. 6-1-5 Priority of terminals during recording DV terminal > S Video terminal > AV terminal Insert Recording Possible. 6-2-1 Insert-capable tape Only tapes with SP recording can be used in Insert Recording. Audio Dubbing Recording Possible. 6-3-1 Audio Dubbing- capable tapes Only tapes with 12- bit/ SP recording (other than 4- channel simultaneous recording) can be used in Audio Dubbing Recording. 6-3-2 Audio dubbing signal input Audio signal from LINE (AV terminal) or microphone (external > internal). 6-3-3 Switching To Audio Dubbing Switch by pressing the Audio Dubbing button on the remote control during Playback Pause. Playback functions Standard Playback and Superb Playback 6-4-1 Standard Playback a. Video Video recorded in SP and LP modes b. Audio 16-bit Supports the following sampling frequencies: 48 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 32 kHz. 12-bit Sampling frequency: 32 kHz Stereo 1, Stereo 2, or mixed playback of Stereo 1 and Stereo 2 (variable mix ratio) 6-4-2 Superb Playback Plays video only a. Still image playback Pure frame playback b. Fast-forward playback Approx. 9.5× speed. c. Rewind playback Approx. 9.5× speed. d. Frame playback Forward/reverse frame feeding e. Slow playback Forward/reverse 1/3× speed f. 1× SP playback Forward/reverse 1× speed g. 2× SP playback Forward/reverse 2× speed h. Edit search Forward/reverse 1× speed Tape fast-forward/rewind time Approx. 2 minutes. 20 seconds. (using 60-minute tape) 1-18 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-6 Input signals 6-6-1 DV terminal SD format signals complying with IEEE1394– AV/ C protocol 6-6-2 AV terminal a. Video signals NTSC standard color video signals Impedance 75 Ω Signal level 1Vp-p (composite) b. Audio signals Signal type Stereo audio signals Impedance 40 KΩ or higher Signal level −10dBv 6-6-3 S Video terminal Signal configuration NTSC Y/C separated video signal Impedance 75 Ω Signal level 0.286Vp-p (color burst signal) 6-6-4 Microphone terminal Impedance 5 KΩ or higher Level −57dBv (using 600 Ω microphone) 6-6-5 USB port (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Conforms to USB 1.1. 6-7 Output signals 6-7-1 DV terminal 6-7-2 AV terminal a. Video signals Signal configuration Output impedance Output signal level Horizontal resolution Self re-recording Camera EE out b. Audio signals Signal type Output impedance Output signal level Frequency characteristic Audio signal S/N For microphone input For external microphone input 6-7-3 S-video terminal Signal configuration Video signal Color signal Brightness signal S/N Horizontal ressolutin Self re-recording Camera EE out Complies with IEEE1394– AV/ C protocol NTSC standard color video signals 75 Ω 1Vp-p (composite) Approx. 430 TV lines (screen center) Approx. 430 TV lines (screen center) Catalog value: Approx. 430 TV lines (screen center) Stereo audio signals 3 KΩ or less −10dBv (with 47 KΩ load) 80 Hz to 12 KHz (1 KHz reference ±10 dB range) 48dB or higher 48dB or higher NTSC Y/C separated video signal 1 Vp- p (brightness + synchronization signal) 0. 286 Vp- p (color burst signal) 45dB or higher Conforms to camera EEout Approx. 430 TV lines (screen center) Catalog value: Approx. 400 TV lines (screen center) 6-7-4 Headphone terminal Also serves as AV I/ O terminal (switched through menu screen) Output impedance 47Ω Output signal level −25dBv (with 16Ω load at maximum volume) 6-7-5 USB port (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Supports USB 1.1. Compatible computer systems Windows systems : IBM-compatible PC/ ATs, NEC PC98- NX Series Macintosh systems : Power Macintosh, PowerBook, iMac, iBook Computer operating system Windows systems : Windows 98, Windows 98SE, Windows ME, Windows 2000, Windows XP Macintosh systems : Mac OS 8. 6 to X 1-19 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-8 Memory card system (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) 6-8-1 Types of memory cards used SD memory card, Multimedia card. 6-8-2 Recordable image types and image quality Camera Card mode Camera still images can be recorded by pressing the Photo button, and motion video can be recorded by operating the Start/ Stop button. (ZR70 MC A only) The Digital Effects function or Multi- screen function can be used. VCR card mode Still images can be recorded by pressing the Photo button (depress halfway to display still image, depress fully to record) during tape playback, and motion video can be recorded by operating the Start/ Stop button (approx. 10 seconds at 320 × 240 pixels and approx. 30 seconds at 160 × 120 pixels, 15 frames/ second). (ZR70 MC A only) Also, DV input still images (no tape loaded or tape stopped) can be recorded by pressing the Photo button (depress halfway to display DV input still image, depress fully to record), and motion video (15 frames/ second) can be recorded by operating the Start/ Stop button. Quality of still images recorded from tape or DV input to card Source Tape photo recording using ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A Motion video recording DV input Line input 6-8-3 File names/folder names Recording mode Image recorded on card NTSC/ PAL models Progressive Frame images NTSC/ PAL models NTSC/ PAL models NTSC/ PAL models Simple pure frame images Simple pure frame images Simple pure frame images The following folder names and file names are used for images saved to memory card after formatting using the Format menu, based on DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) rules, still image (Exif 2.2) file management specifications, and DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) file management specifications. CANON DV Card volume label File types Still image (Exif) file Movie video file Motion video thumbnail file * Photo stitch Zoom browser DPOF file Work file Compression format JPEG Motion JPEG JPEG JPEG JPEG TEXT TEXT Folder name and file name //DCIM/xxxCANON/IMG_yyyy.JPG //DCIM/xxxCANON/MVI_yyyy.JPG //DCIM/xxxCANON/MVI_yyyy.THM //DCIM/xxxCANON/STz_yyyy.JPG //DCIM/xxxCANON/AUT_yyyy.JPG //MISC/AUTPRINT.MRK //DCIM/CANONMSC/xxx.tmp Here, xxx stands for folder number, yyyy for file number, and z for letter from A to Z. * Corresponds to motion video file with same file number. DCF folder and file namd //DCIM/xxxCANON/AUT_yyyy.JPG xxx : Folder No., yyyy : File No. File number Files are managed internally in the format Folder Number–File Number. Photographed images are assigned file numbers between 0001 and 9900, and 100 image files are stored per folder. Individual folders are assigned numbers from 100 to 998 (but the numbers 199, 299, 399, 499, 599, 699, 799, and 899 are not used). Relationship between folder numbers and file numbers Folder numbers File numbers Stored files 100 0001 0002 0003 ・・・・ 0099 0100 101 0101 0102 0103 ・・・・ 0199 0200 102 0201 0202 0203 ・・・・ 0299 0300 198 9801 9802 9803 ・・・・ 9899 9900 200 0001 0002 0003 ・・・・ 0099 0100 9801 9802 9803 ・・・・ 9899 9900 Sample images included at time of shipping ・・・ Photographed image recording area ・・・ 998 Photographed images start with the number 101-0101, and as a basic rule are numbered so as to be greater than the Directory Number–File Number of files residing on a Memory card. 1-20 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-8-4 Still image recorded image size XGA 1024(H) × 768(V) pixels Number of recorded still images (SDC-8M) Super Fine mode 14 (file size per image: approx. 440 kb) Fine mode 20 (file size per image: approx. 300 kb) Standard mode 39 (file size per image: approx. 160 kb) 6-8-5 Motion video recorded image size NTSC 320(H) × 240(V) pixels, 160(H) × 120(V) pixels 15 frame/second Continuous recording time Per shot Approx. 10 seconds (Approx. 1.7MB), Approx. 30 second (Approx. 2.7MB) Per size second Approx. 170KB, Approx. 90KB 6-8-6 Card format Cards should be formatted using the format command in the camcorder's menu. Cards formatted on a PC cannot be guaranteed to function properly as they may malfunction depending on the operating system. 6-8-7 Stitch Assist function This is an effective way to combine (“stitch” together) photographed images to create a panoramic image, using a computer. (The supplied PhotoStitch program is used to combine images on the user’s computer.) The stitch process works by finding the common portions of images that adjoin each other, so the user should frame images in such a way that the common portions contain a distinctive subject (a subject that serves as a landmark). The common portions in each image should constitute between 30% and 50% of the frame width. Also, unevenness at the top and bottom should not exceed 10% of the frame height. 6-9 Digital feature playback functions The following modes are provided: Fader, Effect, Multi-screen. · Can be executed once when Fader mode is displayed in conjunction with pressing the / button (the mode display disappears when Fader ends). · Effects : Effects are sustained until this function is turned off. · Multi-screen : A number of images, equal to the number of screen windows, are captured and displayed manually or each time a fixed time passes. The display remains until this function is turned off. Audio synchronized Fader 6-9-1 Fader Fade time 6-9-2 Effects As in Photo mode, Auto Fade (Japanese models: White Fade; overseas models: Black Fade), Wipe, Corner Wipe, Jump, Flip, Puzzle, Zigzag, Beam, Tide Approx. 4 seconds As in Photo mode, Art, Black and White, Sepia,Mosaic, Ball, Cube, Wave, Color Mask, Mirror (Black and White only in card recording mode) The effects function is toggled ON/OFF by pressing the D. Effect button. 6-9-3 Multi-screen Number of screens Operating modes 6-9-4 Card mix 6-9-5 Availability in operation modes 4 (2 × 2), 9 (3 × 3), 16 (4 × 4) Manual, Fast (every 4 frames), Normal (every 6 frames), Slow (every 8 frames) Cannot be used. Playback (VCR/tape) Card playback (VCR/card (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only)) Fader × Effects × Multi-screen × Card Mix (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) × × 1-21 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-10 Direct print (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) After connecting the camcorder to the BJ 535PD or BJ 895PD camera direct printer using the DIF-100 direct interface cable supplied with the printer, the user can easily print out still images stored on a memory card. Compatible with DPOF printer settings (image and number of copies). 6-10-1 Printable images On the ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, still image files stored on an SD memory card or MultiMediaCard only. 6-10-2 Print format Single-image printing. Printing of index sheets is not supported. Supported paper sizes are L, LL, postcard, A4, and card. Refer to the specifications of the BJ 535PD or BJ 895 PD printer for information on compatible paper sizes. 6-10-3 Trimming Not supported. 6-10-4 Date stamp Not supported. 6-10-5 Number of copies printed Can be specified between 1 and 99. 6-11 Other functions 6-11-1 Consecutive shooting mechanism Can be used starting in Recording Pause or Stop mode, or starting with the power off. This does not apply to cases where the cassette has been removed. 6-11-2 Automatic stop function This function is activated in the following cases: · When forward still image playback is continued for approx. 5 minutes, or reverse still image playback is continued for approx. 5minutes · When a condensation warning is displayed · When the tape end or beginning is reached 6-11-3 Automatic power-off mechanism Camera tape mode After recording has been paused continuously for approximately 5 minutes. When the battery voltage drops below the specified value. Camera card mode After a period of approximately 5 minutes elapses with the card inserted. When the battery voltage drops below the specified value. 6-11-4 Time code Automatically written during recording. Time code values range from 0:00:00:00 to 7:59:59:29 (hours:minutes:seconds:frames). 6-11-5 Photo search This function searches for images shot in Photo mode. Forward/reverse photo search (use the , keys on the remote control after selecting Photo 6-11-6 Date search Search with the remote control Search Select key) Values can be entered in a range of up to the ± 10th photo from the current position. If there is more than one recording date, this function cue up to the position where the date changes. Forward/reverse date search (use the 6-11-7 World clock display , keys on the remote control after selecting Date Search with the remote control Search Select key) Values can be entered in a range of up to the ± 10th photo from the current position. After setting a reference city (the city where the clock's time is set), when you take a picture, select the name of the city where you are shooting. The date and time will be automatically changed to the local date and time, and recorded in the data code. 6-11-8 Speaker Built-in speaker. with volume adjustment 6-11-9 File transfer (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) When the USB port on the PC and the USB port on the camcorder are connected using the included interface cable (IFC-300PCU), still images (JPEG files) and motion video (Motion JPEG files) recorded on the memory card can be transferred to the PC. If the "ZoomBrowser" program (for Windows) or "ImageBrowser" program (for Macintosh) on the included Digital Video Solution Disk is installed on the PC in advance, you can transfer the desired images to the PC while viewing thumbnails of the still images recorded on the memory card. 6-11-10 A/D conversion This function performs real-time conversion of analog AV signals input to the AV terminal into digital DV signals and outputs them through the DV terminal. When an 8 mm video player or VHS video player is connected with the camcorder using an AV cable, and the camcorder is connected to a PC using a DV cable, playback images can be transferred from the 8 mm tape or VHS tape to the PC. (Under the VCR settings on the VCR menu screen, set "AV input → DV Output" to ON. 1-22 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-11-11 Playback zoom When viewing images recorded on tape or card (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only,still images only), moving the Zoom lever to the Telephoto side causes the image being displayed to appear at 2x magnification. Moving the Zoom lever back to the Wide side causes the image to be displayed at its original (unmagnified) size. When viewing an enlarged image, the Multi-dial can be used to change the portion of the image that is displayed. (In LCD monitor, a frame indicating the magnified portion is displayed along with and indications showing the directions in which movement is possible using the Multi-dial.) To toggle between up-down and left-right movement, the user presses the Multidial. (The default setting when switching to 2x magnification is left-right movement.) ⇒ 6-11-12 Battery charge function Charging time (with power supply switch OFF) 7 Terminals and ports 7-1 DV terminal 7-2 S-video terminal 7-3 AV (Video/audio) terminal 7-4 External microphone input terminal 7-5 Headphone terminal 7-6 Memory card connection terminal 7-7 Battery terminal 7-8 DC IN terminal 7-9 USB port 8 Power supply 8-1 Input power 8-2 Power consumption ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 9 Dimensions (W × H × D) 10 Weight 10-1 Camcorder alone ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 10-2 Total equipped weight ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A By connecting to Canon compact power adapter CA-570, the battery pack installed at the battery pack installing section can be charged. (When charging is performed, the charge lamp flashes (1flash for the charged amount ranged from 0% to approx. 75%; 2-flash for the charged amount ranged from 75% to 95%) or lights up (at full charge, that is, 95% or more.) BP-508: Approx. 110 min., BP-511/512: Approx. 120 min., BP-522: Approx. 210 min., BP-535: Approx. 310 min. Special 4-pin connector (IEEE1394 compatible); input and output 4-pin mini-DIN, input and output φ 3.5mm, 4-pole pin jack (yellow); input and output also serves as headphone terminal φ 3.5mm stereo mini jack φ 3.5mm stereo mini jack (also serves as AV terminal) Special multi-pin (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Special 3-pin φ 3.4mm jack 5-pin (mini-B Receptacle; ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) 7.4V DC (battery pack), 8.4V DC (DC IN). During shooting : Approx. 2.9 W (using CVF); approx. 3.8 W (using LCD monitor) During playback : Approx. 4.2 W (using LCD monitor) During shooting : Approx. 2.9 W (using CVF); approx. 3.8 W (using LCD monitor) During playback : Approx. 4.2 W (using LCD monitor) During shooting : Approx. 2.9 W (using CVF); approx. 3.8 W (using LCD monitor) During playback : Approx. 4.2 W (using LCD monitor) Approx. 58 × 103 × 147 mm (approx. 2.3 in × 4.1 × 5.8 in) (excluding small projections) Approx. 525 g (approx. 1.2 lb) Approx. 520 g (approx. 1.1 lb) Approx. 520 g (approx. 1.1 lb) Approx. 625 g (approx. 1.4 lb) *1 Approx. 610 g (approx. 1.3 lb) *2 Approx. 610 g (approx. 1.3 lb) *3 *1 : (including BP-512, DVM-E30, lens cap, coin-type lithium battery, SDC-8M, grip belt) *2 : (including BP-508, DVM-E30, lens cap, coin-type lithium battery, SDC-8M, grip belt) *3 : (including BP-508, DVM-E30, lens cap, coin-type lithium battery, grip belt) 11 Temperature and humidity requirements 11-1 Temperature and humidity requirements for performance 0°C to 40°C, maximum 85% relative humidity 11-2 Temperature and humidity requirements for operation −5°C to 45°C, maximum 65% relative humidity 1-23 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 4. System Diagram (Common to all Models) WS-20 Wrist Strap ZR70 MC SS-800 Shoulder Strap WA-30.5Wide Attachment ZR70 MC ZR65 MC WD-30.5Wideconverter WL-D79 Wireless Controller ZR60 WL-D80 Wireless Controller BP-500 Series Battery Pack CG-570 Battery Charger CB-570 Car Battery Cable MiniDV Video Cassette TL-30.5Teleconverter CA-570 Compact Power Adapter FS-30.5U Filter Set BP-500 Series Battery Pack S-150 S-video Cable ZR70 MC VL-3 Video Light TV STV-250N StereoVideo Cable VCR ZR70 MC DM-50 Directional Stereo Microphone Commercially available DV Cable Digital Device ZR70 MC ZR65 MC PC Card Adapter BP-900 Series Battery Pack* VL-10Li Battery Video Light Stereo Microphone (commercially available) SD Memory Card USB Reader/Writer FD Adapter MultiMediaCard IFC-300PCU USB Cable Computer Bubble Jet Printer with direct print function SC-1000 Soft Carrying Case SC-A50 Soft Carrying Case Fig. 1-2 1-24 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5. Overview of Viewfinder / LCD Panel Displays 5-1 Camera Mode MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Camera mode Zoom display (displayed for approx. four seconds after zooming) Optical zooming W T 88 × digital zooming W 440 × digital zooming W Zooming stopped W T Zoominging to tele end W T Zoominging to wide end W T T For ZR65 MC A at 80× and ZR60 A at 72× T For ZR65 MC A at 400× and ZR60 A at 360× Image stabilizer display The image stabilizer is ON The image stabilizer is OFF No display Recording mode display SD mode During SP recording During LP recording Operation mode display During mirror shooting mirror mode (LCD) Recording Red display Record pause Green display Playback is stopped Green display Cassette is ejected Green display + REC search Green display − REC search Green display 1-25 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Program AE mode display Full Auto mode is selected Auto mode is selected Sports mode is selected Portrait mode is selected Spotlight mode is selected Surf & snow mode is selected Low light mode is selected Night mode is selected Super Night mode is selected ZR70 MC A only Program AE mode menu Super Night mode is for ZR70 MC A only. Tape counter display Time code display Not entered Zero Set Memory M M M Not entered M AE shift display Minimum exposure value When standard value is set Maximum exposure value During AE No display 1-26 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Timer display Remaining tape display At end of tape Not entered Tape warning display Other Flashes red No display Focus mode display AF OFF Infinity focus AF ON No display Self timer display Self timer standby Timer operating Other No display Battery power display Approx. 75% remaining. Approx. 50% remaining. Approx. 25% remaining. Approx. Power adapter is connected No display 1-27 0% remaining. Flashes red ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Shutter speed display 1/60 sec. 1/100 sec. 1/250 sec. 1/500 sec. 1/1000 sec. 1/2000 sec. Auto No display White balance display Set Indoor preset Outdoor preset Auto No display Condensation warning display Remote sensor code display Code 1 setting Code 2 setting Sensor OFF Headphone volume adjustment display Volume OFF Card mix display (For ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) 1-28 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Digital feature display Fade Tigger Wipe (horizontal) Corner Wipe Jump Flip Puzzle Zigzag Beam Tide Art Black and White Sepia Mosaic Ball Cube Wave Color Mask Mirror Multi-screen Feature OFF No display Digital feature menu 1-29 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Digital Feature selection Press the “D.E. SEL” button in Camera mode, VCR mode, or Card Recording mode. The line where the cursor is located in the menu is surrounded with a turquoise frame. The previously selected items and the corresponding settings are shown in yellow. OFF In Fader Selection In Effect Selection In Multi Screen Selection In Multi Screen Speed Selection In Multi Screen Count Selection 1-30 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Wind screen display Wind screen ON Wind screen OFF ON No display Time and date display When time and date are not set Audio mode display 16-bit is selected 12-bit is selected 16 : 9 mode display 16:9 mode is selected Other No display Half-press lock display Photo mode display Normal recording No display Photo mode is selected 1-31 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-2 VCR Mode MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS VCR mode Audio output display 12-bit Stereo 1 is selected 12-bit Stereo 2 is selected 12-bit Mix 1:1 is selected 12-bit Mix variable is selected 16-bit No display Audio Mix Balance display ST-1:ST-2 = 1:0 ST-1:ST-2 = 1:1 ST-1:ST-2 = 0:1 Recording mode display During SP recording During LP recording Operating mode display During Recording Red display During Recording pause Cassette is ejected Playback is stopped Playback Fast-forward Rewind No tape Fast-forward playback 2× SP playback 1× SP playback Slow playback Frame advance playback 1-32 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Still image playback Reverse still image playback Frame reverse playback Slow reverse playback 1× SP reverse playback 2× SP reverse playback Rewind playback Forward edit search Reverse edit search Forward date/photo search Reverse date/photo search FF return REW return AV insert pause AV insert recording Audio dubbing pause Audio dubbing recording Red display Tape counter Time code display Not entered Zero set memory Same as during Camera mode Remaining tape display Same as during Camera mode Audio dubbing/insert or search operation display AV insert is selected Audio dubbing is selected Date search operation Still image photo search operation Other than search Battery power display No display Same as during Camera mode 1-33 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Remote sensor code display Same as during Camera mode Battery warning display Same as during Camera mode Condensation warning display Same as during Camera mode REMARKS Speaker volume adjustment display Volume OFF Headphone volume adjustment display Same as during Camera mode Data code display Date and time selection Date and time Data code setting Camera data Date and time & camera data Date setting Time setting Date & time setting Camera data F-number display F-number closed This product has no F-number full-close When not entered function. Shutter speed display The shutter speed of this product ranges from 1/8, 1/60 to 1/2000 sec. When not entered 1-34 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Time display Time setting is selected Not entered Time and time setting are selected Not entered Date display Not entered Wind screen display Same as during Camera mode Audio data display Audio dubbing/audio input terminal Audio dubbing/micro-phone input terminal Audio mode display Same as during Camera mode 16 : 9 mode display Same as during Camera mode DV display During DV input AV input → DV signal conversion Other No display 1-35 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-3 Card/Camera Mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Card / Camera mode Zoom display Same as during Camera mode Card recording image quality display Program AE mode display Full Auto mode Auto mode Sports mode Portrait mode Spotlight mode Surf & snow mode Low light mode Low light + mode ZR70 MC A only Stitch assist number of photos display Card access display 1-36 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Card free space display No card (flashes red) Accidental erasure protection 9999 or more images can be recorded 99 images can be recorded displayed green for 6 or more images 5 images can be recorded displayed yellow for 1 to 5 images 0 images can be recorded displayed red for 0 images AE shift display Same as during Camera mode Card motion video recording time display 320 × 240 pixels 160 × 120 pixels Still image size display 1024 × 768 pixels 640 × 480 pixels Motion video size display × (ZR70 MC A only) 160 × 120 pixels Focus mode display Same as during Camera mode Self timer display Same as during Camera mode Battery power display Same as during Camera mode Shutter speed display Lithium battery low-power warning display Same as during Camera mode Remote sensor code display Same as during Camera mode White balance display Same as during Camera mode Battery low-power warning display Same as during Camera mode Condensation warning display Same as during Camera mode 1-37 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION Digital feature display NORTH AMERICA MODEL Same as during Camera mode (but with no fader function) Time and date display Same as during Camera mode (Date and time only) Half-press lock display Same as during Camera mode 1-38 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-4 Card Playback Mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Card play mode Slideshow display DPOP designation display Protect mark display DCF file name display Directory Number-File Number Card access display Writting to card Shown in red, displayed in sequence Reading from card Shown in green, displayed in sequence 1-39 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL REMARKS Image number display No card Flashes red Checking number of images recorded on card 0 recorded images 9th of 99 recorded images 99th of 99 recorded images 9999th of 9999 recorded images Image size display Volume display (ZR70 MC A only) Same as during VCR mode Data code display Same as during VCR mode (Date and time only) Slideshow operation guidance display During slideshow execution 1-40 During moving image playback ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-5 Menu Display Camera mode, VCR mode, Card/Camera mode, and Card Playback mode are provided in the menu display. Camera Mode MAIN MENU ITEM CARD MIX *1 CAM. SET UP SUB MENU ITEM SHUTTER IMAGE S. 16 : 9 WHIT BAL. RETURN REC MODE AV/PHONES AUD. SET UP RETURN WIND SCREEN AUDIO MODE DISP. SET UP DEFAULT BACKUP Go to Card mix selection screen D. ZOOM VCR SET UP SETTINGS AUTO 1/60 1/100 1/250 1/500 1/1000 1/2000 OFF 88× / 80× / 72× 440× / 400× / 360× ON OFF ON OFF AUTO SET INDOOR OUTDOOR AUTO Lithium battery 88× / 80× / 72× Lithium battery ON Lithium battery OFF Lithium battery AUTO Lithium battery SP LP AV PHONES SP Lithium battery AV Lithium battery ON OFF 16 bit 12 bit ON Lithium battery 12 bit Lithium battery RETURN BRIGHTNESS *2 LCD MIRROR *2 TV SCREEN D/T DISPLAY *2 Lithium battery ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF 1-41 ON Lithium battery ON Lithium battery OFF Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM SUB MENU ITEM DISP. SET UP DEMO MODE SYSTEM RETURN BUTTON LIGHT *3 LIGHT COLOR *3 SETTINGS DEFAULT ON OFF OFF Lithium battery ON PUSH ON OFF GREEN ORANGE BLUE YELLOW TURQUOISE PURPLE ON Lithium battery TURQUOISE Lithium battery WL REMOTE *4 BEEP *2 T. ZONE/DST *4 D/TIME SEL *4 BACKUP Lithium battery OFF ON OFF LONDON LONDON PARIS PARIS ······ CAIRO MOSCOW DUBAI KARACHI DACCA BANGKOK H.KONG TOKYO SYDNEY SOLOMON WELLGTN SAMOA HONOLU. ANCHOR L.A. DENVER CHICAGO N.Y. CARACAS RIO FERNEN. ······ AZORES AZORES JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM DEC.31, 2030 11:59 PM RETURN 1-42 ON Lithium battery N.Y. Lithium battery JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM MY CAMERA SUB MENU ITEM SHTR SOUND S-UP SOUND S/STOP SOUND SELF-T SOUND SETTINGS PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 DEFAULT BACKUP PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery RETURN CLOSE MENU *1 : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model only. *2 : BEEP, BRIGHTNESS, MIRROR, and D/T DISPLAY information is not displayed on screens other than the menu screen. *3 : *4 : ZR70 MC A model only. On screens other than the menu screen, displayed for 4 seconds at power-on and when the menu is closed. Note that this applies to the D/TIME SEL only when OFF is selected for D/T DISPLAY. Also, WL. REMOTE “OFF ( displayed at all times. 1-43 )” is ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT VCR Mode MAIN MENU ITEM VCR SET UP SUB MENU ITEM REC MODE AV/PHONES AV AUD. SET UP DV OUT RETURN OUTPUT CH *1 AUDIO MODE 12 bit AUDIO OUT SETTINGS DEFAULT SP LP AV PHONES ON OFF SP Lithium battery AV Lithium battery OFF Reset when power is turned off L/R L/L R/R 16bit 12bit STEREO 1 STEREO 2 MIX/FIXED MIX/VARI. L/R Reset when power is turned off 12bit Lithium battery STEREO 1 Reset when power is turned off MIX BALANCE AUDIO DUB. WIND SCREEN CARD SET UP *2 RETURN SI QUALITY MOVIE SIZE IMAGE NOS. CARD OPER. *2 DISP. SET UP RETURN COPY [ ] ] RETURN BRIGHTNESS *1 DISPLAYS 6 SEC. DATE *1 DATA CODE *3 D/TIME SEL *3 BACKUP Lithium battery AUDIO IN MIC. IN ON OFF AUDIO IN Lithium battery ON Lithium battery SUPER FINE FINE NORMAL 320 × 240 160 × 120 RESET CONTINUOUS FINE Lithium battery 320 × 240 Lithium battery CONTINUOUS Lithium battery Go to Copy execution screen Lithium battery ON OFF ON OFF DATE/TIME CAMERA DATA CAM. & D/T DATE TIME DATE & TIME RETURN 1-44 ON Lithium battery OFF Lithium battery DATE/TIME Lithium battery DATE & TIME Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM SYSTEM SUB MENU ITEM BUTTON LIGHT *4 LIGHT COLOR *4 SETTINGS ON PUSH ON OFF GREEN ORANGE BLUE YELLOW TURQUOISE PURPLE DEFAULT ON Lithium battery GREEN Lithium battery WL REMOTE *2 BEEP *1 T. ZONE/DST *5 D/TIME SEL *5 BACKUP Lithium battery OFF ON OFF LONDON LONDON PARIS PARIS ······ CAIRO MOSCOW DUBAI KARACHI DACCA BANGKOK H.KONG TOKYO SYDNEY SOLOMON WELLGTN SAMOA HONOLU. ANCHOR L.A. DENVER CHICAGO N.Y. CARACAS RIO FERNEN. ······ AZORES AZORES JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM DEC.31, 2030 11:59 PM RETURN 1-45 ON Lithium battery N.Y. Lithium battery JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM MY CAMERA SUB MENU ITEM SHTR SOUND S-UP SOUND S/STOP SOUND SELF-T SOUND SETTINGS PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 DEFAULT BACKUP PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery RETURN CLOSE MENU *1 : BRIGHTNESS, 6 SEC. DATE, OUTPUT CH, and BEEP information is not displayed on screens other than the menu *2 : screen. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model only. *3 : *4 : Displayed only when DATA CODE is ON on screens other than the menu screen. ZR70 MC A model only. *5 : On screens other than the menu screen, displayed for 4 seconds at power-on and when the menu is closed. Note that this applies to the D/TIME SEL only when OFF is selected for D/T DISPLAY. 1-46 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Card Camera Mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) MAIN MENU ITEM CAM. SET UP SUB MENU ITEM SHUTTER WHIT BAL CARD SET UP RETURN SI QUALITY SI SIZE MOVIE SIZE FILE NOS. *1 VCR SET UP RETURN AV/PHONES AUD. SET UP RETURN WIND SCREEN DISP. SET UP RETURN BRIGHTNESS *2 LCD MIRROR *2 TV SCREEN D/T DISPLAY *2 DEMO MODE SYSTEM RETURN BUTTON LIGHT *3 LIGHT COLOR *3 SETTINGS AUTO 1/60 1/100 1/250 AUTO SET INDOOR OUTDOOR DEFAULT AUTO Lithium battery AUTO Lithium battery FINE Lithium battery 1024 × 768 Lithium battery 320 × 240 Lithium battery CONTINUOS Lithium battery AV PHONES AV Lithium battery ON OFF ON Lithium battery SUPER FINE FINE NORMAL 1024 × 768 640 × 480 320 × 240 160 × 120 RESET CONTINUOS Lithium battery ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON PUSH ON OFF GREEN ORANGE BLUE YELLOW TURQUOISE PURPLE ON Lithium battery ON Lithium battery OFF Lithium battery OFF Lithium battery ON Lithium battery BLUE Lithium battery WL REMOTE *2 BEEP *2 BACKUP Lithium battery OFF ON OFF ON 1-47 Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM SYSTEM SUB MENU ITEM T. ZONE/DST *2 D/TIME SEL *2 SETTINGS LONDON LONDON PARIS PARIS ······ CAIRO MOSCOW DUBAI KARACHI DACCA BANGKOK H.KONG TOKYO SYDNEY SOLOMON WELLGTN SAMOA HONOLU. ANCHOR L.A. DENVER CHICAGO N.Y. CARACAS RIO FERNEN. ······ AZORES AZORES JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM DEFAULT BACKUP N.Y. Lithium battery JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM Lithium battery PATTERN1 LITHIUM BATTERY PATTERN1 LITHIUM BATTERY PATTERN1 LITHIUM BATTERY PATTERN1 LITHIUM BATTERY DEC.31, 2030 11:59 PM MY CAMERA RETURN SHTR SOUND S-UP SOUND S/STOP SOUND SELF-T SOUND PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 RETURN CLOSE MENU *1 : BEEP, BRIGHTNESS, MIRROR, D/T DISPLAY, FILE NOS., and SHTR SOUND information is not displayed on screens other than the menu screen. *2 : On screens other than the menu screen, displayed for 4 seconds at power-on and when the menu is closed. Note that this applies to the D/TIME SEL only when OFF is selected for D/T DISPLAY. Also, WL. REMOTE “OFF ( displayed at all times. *3 : ZR70 MC A model only. 1-48 )” is ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT Card Playback Mode (Card/VCR Mode) (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) MAIN MENU ITEM CARD OPER. (Single screen) CARD OPER. (Index screen) SUB MENU ITEM COPY [ ] DEFAULT Go to the Image erase screen FORMAT Go to the Format screen RETURN PROTECT RETURN REC MODE AV/PHONES BACKUP Go to the Copy execution screen PRINT ORDERS ALL ERASE IMAGE ERASE PRINT ORDER VCR SET UP SETTINGS Go to the Print oders allerase screen Go to Image Protect Go to Print order SP LP AV PHONES screen screen SP Lithium battery AV Reset when power is turned off RETURN DISP. SET UP BRIGHTNESS *1 DISPLAY D/TIME SEL *2 SYSTEM RETURN BUTTON LIGHT *3 LIGHT COLOR *3 Lithium battery ON OFF DATE TIME DATE & TIME ON Lithium battery DATE & TIME Lithium battery ON PUSH ON OFF GREEN ORANGE BLUE YELLOW TURQUOISE PURPLE ON Lithium battery YELLOW Lithium battery WL REMOTE *1 BEEP *2 Lithium battery OFF ON OFF ON 1-49 Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM SYSTEM SUB MENU ITEM T. ZONE/DST *4 D/TIME SEL *4 SETTINGS LONDON LONDON PARIS PARIS ······ CAIRO MOSCOW DUBAI KARACHI DACCA BANGKOK H.KONG TOKYO SYDNEY SOLOMON WELLGTN SAMOA HONOLU. ANCHOR L.A. DENVER CHICAGO N.Y. CARACAS RIO FERNEN. ······ AZORES AZORES JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM DEC.31, 2030 11:59 PM PRINT ORDER *5 RETURN Go to the Print order screen 1-50 DEFAULT BACKUP N.Y. Lithium battery JAN. 1, 2003 12:00 AM Lithium battery ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MAIN MENU ITEM MY CAMERA SUB MENU ITEM SETTINGS DEFAULT CREATE START-UP Go to the Startup screen creation screen SEL. S-UP IMG NO PICTURE CANON LOGO MY PICTURE PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 PATTERN1 PATTERN2 PATTERN3 SHTR SOUND S-UP SOUND S/STOP SOUND SELF-T SOUND BACKUP CANON LOGO Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery PATTERN1 Lithium battery RETURN RETURN *1: BRIGHTNESS and BEEP information is not displayed on screens other than the menu screen. *2: *3: Displayed only when DATA CODE is ON on screens other than the menu screen. ZR70 MC A model only. *4: *5: On screens other than the menu screen, displayed for 4 seconds at power-on and when the menu is closed. Displayed only when connected to a camera direct printer. Note that this applies to the D/TIME SEL only when OFF is selected for D/T DISPLAY. 1-51 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-6 Card-Related Screen Displays MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Slideshow screen Index screen Image protect screen Print order screen 1-52 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Copy screen Copy ( ) selection screen Copy ( ) execution screen Copy ( ) selection screen Copy ( ) execution screen 1-53 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Image erase screen Image erase selection screen Erasing one image Warning: Erasing in progress Erasing all images 1-54 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Format screen Format execution confirmation screen Format execution screen 1-55 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Card mix selection screen Mix type setting screen Animation type setting screen Mix level setting screen 1-56 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Stitch assist screen My camera settings My camera settings screen Startup image creation screen Select recording position 1-57 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL My camera settings Record execution confirmation Message during image creation Startup image selection screen Shutter sound selection screen Startup sound selection screen 1-58 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL My camera settings Start/stop selection screen Self-timer sound selection screen PC connection screen displays USB connection IEEE1394 connection 1-59 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-7 Direct Print Setting Screen MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Direct print setting screen Direct print setting initial screen Print selection screen L Size Borderless Style L Size Borderless SET Now printing (1/1) 1 Copies Print Cancel Print stop screen L Size Borderless Now printing (1/3) Cancel SET L Size Borderless L Size Borderless SET Two sheets remain. Cancel ? Two sheets remain. Cancel ? OK OK Cancel Cancel SET Cancel selection screen L Size Borderless Style 1 OK SET Copies Cancel Direct Print Cancel 1-60 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Direct print setting screen Number of copies setting screen L Size Bordered Style 1 Print Copies Cancel SW L Size Bordered L Size Bordered Style Style Setting Print 1 Copies Cancel Setting 2 Print Copies Cancel SET (Quantity set by Multi switch) L Size Bordered Style 2 Print 1-61 Copies Cancel ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL Direct print setting screen Style setting screen L Size Borderless Style 1 Copies Print Cancel Go to the style setting screen using MENU buttons SET Style Style Paper Setting Borders SELECT Borderless L Size MENU MENU SET SET Style Style Borders Paper Setting L Size Borderless MENU MENU SELECT SELECT Style Style Borders Paper Setting LL Size Bordered MENU MENU MENU L Size Borderless Style 1 Print 1-62 Copies Cancel ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-8 Print MENU INDICATION NORTH AMERICA MODEL OK screen SET L Size Borderless 9999 Style SET Print all marketed images OK Resume L Size Borderless 9999 Now Printing (1/9999) Cancel Cancel Print stop screen L Size Borderless 9999 L Size Borderless 9999 SET Now Printing (1/9999) Cancel ? Cancel OK Cancel SET Set-print Mode cancel. Print restart screen 9999 L Size Borderless Style 9999 SET Print remaining Images. OK Resume L Size Borderless Now Printing (1/9999) Cancel Cancel Style setting screen 9999 L Size Borderless Style Style is changed. OK Resume 9999 L Size Borderless SET Style is changed. Cancel OK Resume Cancel Go to the style setting screen 1-63 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 5-9 Warning Displays COPYRIGHT PROTECTED PLAYBACK IS RESTRICTED • When copy-protected tape is played. COPYRIGHT PROTECTED DUBBING RESTRICTED • When copy protection information is detected during DV input or LINE input, or when the signal output from the television or VCR is garbled during analog input. SET THE TIME ZONE, DATE AND TIME • When the power is turned on without setting the area and/or time and date. REMOVE THE CASSETTE • When a cassette is inserted while there is a mechanical error or condensation in the unit. CHECK THE DV INPUT • When “REC” is pressed in a mode that allows transition to REC, without a connection to DV input, or in a condition where the connected DV input cannot be recognized. CHANGE THE BATTERY PACK • When the battery power is low. CONDENSATION HAS BEEN DETECTED • When condensation is detected (if a cassette is inserted, a “REMOVE THE CASSETTE” message appears). THE TAPE IS SET FOR ERASURE PREVENTION • When “REC” is pressed in a mode that allows transition to REC in VCR mode, if the cassette is set for erasure prevention. In Camera mode, when the power is turned ON, when the “Start/Stop” button is pressed, and when a cassette is inserted, if the cassette is set for erasure prevention. TAPE END • When the tape end is detected, or when a key (FF, PLAY, etc.) which drives the tape forward is pressed in a mode that allows transition to forward driving during the detection process. CHECK THE CASSETTE [REC MODE] • When the Audio Dubbing or AV Insert button is pressed at a tape position recorded in LP/ESP/ELP; or when LP mode is detected during Audio Dubbing or AV Insert. CHECK THE CASSETTE [AUDIO MODE] • When the Audio Dubbing button is pressed at a tape position with 16-bit or 4-channel simultaneous recording; or when 16-bit mode or 4-channel simultaneous recording mode is detected during Audio Dubbing. CHECK THE CASSETTE [BLANK] • When a blank tape area is detected during Audio Dubbing or AV Insert. 1-64 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT CARD ERROR • When a card error occurs and data cannot be recorded on the card (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). CARD FULL • When the card is full (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). NAMING ERROR • When the maximum number of file numbers and directory numbers are created (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). UNIDENTIFIABLE IMAGE • When an attempt is made to play an image in an unplayable format, an incompatible JPEG image, or an image with corrupt data (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). PRINT ORDER ERROR • When there are too many print marks ( 201 or more), or when a mark file cannot be edited (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). NO CARD • When there is no card in the camcorder socket (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). NO IMAGES • When there are no images to be played in the card (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). THE CARD IS SET FOR ERASURE PREVENTION • When an attempt is made to record on an SD card set for erasure prevention, in a mode that allows card recording (VCR mode, Card Recording mode) (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). NOW CREATING START-UP IMAGE • The startup image is being written to flash memory (for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A model). CARD MODE • When Start/Stop button is pressed in the Camera mode (for ZR65 MC A model). ** A warning (warning text) is displayed for approx. four seconds in the center of the screen when an abnormality, etc. occurs. ** While the warning (warning text) is displayed, only actions enabling a mode transition are accepted. The warning display disappears simultaneous with the acceptance of such an action. 1-65 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6. Backing Up Various Data 6-1 Backup by Main Power Supply The condensation timer is backed up by the main power supply alone. 6-2 Backup by Main Power Supply or Backup Power Supply (Lithium Coin Primary Battery) The table below lists the item (excluding menu items) backed up by the main power supply or backup power supply (lithium coin primary battery). Item Default Digital zoom position Optical tele end WB data (SET) ---- Time and date settings (auto date) 2003. 1.1 12:00 AM Menu cursor position Very top Time code ---- Mix balance (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Center Headphone volume Center Speaker volume Center Mechanical errors ---- 1-66 Remarks ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-3 Backup Conditions Related to Switch Operation 6-3-1 Turning OFF the Power When Camera mode is in “ In (Program AE)” mode. (Full Auto) mode, after the power is turned on (Camera), the specifications are the same as in 6-3-3 (Switching to “Full Auto”). Item Power switch OFF, VCR ● Camera mode, Card/Camera mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) Program AE mode type Backup Manual focus ON/OFF Backup AE shift setting mode ON/OFF Backup DE, DF ON/OFF Reset (set to OFF) Headphone volume *CAM Backup Self timer ON/OFF Backup (set to OFF) On-screen ON/OFF Backup Zero Set Memory counter value *CAM Backup ● Camera, Card/Camera (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) menu item settings Digital Effects selection Backup *Independent Fader *CAM Backup *Independent Effects Backup *Independent Multi-screen (speed) Backup *Independent Multi-screen (number of screens) Backup *Independent Mix key selection in Card Mix Backup *CAM (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Mix level in Card Mix Backup *CAM (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Shutter speed setting Backup Digital zoom setting Backup *Independent Image stabilizer ON/OFF Backup 16:9 ON/OFF Backup White balance setting Backup Remote control code setting Backup Recording mode setting *CAM Backup Confirmation beep ON/OFF Backup Wind screen ON/OFF Backup Audio mode setting *CAM Backup AV/headphone selection Backup LCD brightness adjustment Backup Mirror shooting setting Backup On-screen ON/OFF Backup Time and Date display Backup Area/daylight saving time setting Backup Time and Date setting Backup Image quality *CD (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) Backup Number reset *CD (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) Backup * CAM : Camera mode only *CD : Card Recording mode only (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) * Independent : Independent backup for Card/Camera mode, Camera mode, and VCR mode The card recording still image selection in Card Mix (Card Mix standby state) is not backed up when the power is turned off. 1-67 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-3-2 Switching the Power Switch to a Different Position Item Power switch OFF ● VCR mode Headphone volume Backup Speaker volume On-screen ON/OFF Backup Reset (set to OFF) Zero Set Memory counter value Backup Data code display ON/OFF Backup Audio 12-bit output selection Reset (set to "Stereo 1") Mix balance setting Photo Search/Date Search for search selection Backup Reset (changes to "Photo Search") ● VCR menu item settings D. Effects selection Backup *Independent Fader *CAM Backup *Independent Effects Backup *Independent Multi-screen (speed) Backup *Independent Multi-screen (number of screens) Backup *Independent Remote control code setting Backup Recording mode setting Backup Data code setting Backup Time and date selection setting Backup LCD brightness adjustment Backup Text display during playback ON/OFF Backup Date Auto display ON/OFF Backup Bilingual setting Reset (set to "Main + Sub") Audio dubbing input setting Backup Wind screen ON/OFF Backup LINE IN audio mode setting Backup AV/headphone selection Reset (set to “AV”) Confirmation beep ON/OFF Backup Image quality (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Backup Number reset (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Backup ● Card Playback mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) On screen ON/OFF Reset (set to OFF) Data code display ON/OFF Reset (set to OFF) ● Card Playback mode menu item selection (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Remote control code setting Backup Recording mode setting Backup Data code setting Backup Time and Date setting Backup LCD brightness adjustment Backup Text display during playback ON/OFF Backup Date Auto display ON/OFF Backup Confirmation beep Backup * Independent : Independent backup for Card Recording mode, Camera mode, and VCR mode 1-68 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 6-3-3 Switching Camera Modes/Switching Program AE Modes The following table presents the backup state performed for various data when the AE) to (Full Auto), or when the / switch is set to Item / switch is switched from (Program and the mode is switched to a different Program AE mode. Switched to (Full Auto) Switched to Program AE mode ● Camera mode, Card/Camera mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Program AE mode type Auto focus ON/OFF AE shift setting mode ON/OFF DE, DF ON/OFF *1 ---- Reset (set to “ON”) Backup Reset (set to “OFF”) *2 Reset (set to OFF) Reset (set to “OFF”) Backup Headphone volume Backup Backup Self timer ON/OFF Backup Backup On screen ON/OFF Backup Backup Zero Set Memory counter value *CAM Backup Backup D. Effects selection Backup *Independent Backup *Independent Fader *CAM Backup *Independent Backup *Independent Effects Backup *Independent Backup *Independent Multi-screen (speed) Backup *Independent Backup *Independent Multi-screen (number of screens) Backup *Independent Backup *Independent Backup Backup Backup Backup Reset Backup Reset (set to “Auto”) Reset (set to “Auto”) Backup Backup Reset (set to “ON”) Backup ● Camera/Card mode (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) menu item settings Mix selection in Card Mix *CAM (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Mix level in Card Mix *CAM (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Card recording image selection in Card Mix (Card Mix standby state) (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Shutter speed Digital zoom ON/OFF Image stabilizer 16:9 *CAM set to “OFF” *2 Backup Reset (set to “Auto”) Backup Remote control code setting Backup Backup Recording mode setting *CAM Backup Backup White balance Confirmation beep Backup Backup Wind screen Backup Backup AV/headphone selection Backup Backup Audio mode *CAM Backup Backup LCD brightness adjustment Backup Backup Mirror shooting setting Backup Backup On screen ON/OFF Backup Backup Time and Date display Backup Backup Area/daylight saving time Backup Backup Time and Date setting Backup Backup Image quality *CD (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Backup Backup Number reset *CD (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Backup Backup * CAM : * Independent : *1 : *2 : Camera mode only *CD : Card Recording mode only (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only) Independent backup for Card Recording mode, Camera mode, and VCR mode is set again, “Auto” is set. When When is set again, the state preceding the switch to “ ” (Full Auto) is restored. • The card recording still image selection in Card Mix (Card Mix standby state) is not backed up, even if there is a switch between Normal and Progressive. • The backup operations at LANC power-OFF and the recording pause 5-minute timer power-OFF are the same as when the power switch is turned OFF. 1-69 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7. Other Features 7-1 Green Mode Default Settings in Green Mode • Focus ------------------------- AUTO • Exposure -------------------- AUTO • White balance --------------- AUTO • DE, DF ---------------------- OFF • Image stabilizer ------------- ON • Shutter ----------------------- AUTO • 16:9 -------------------------- OFF Other settings are the same as before even when the mode is changed to Green mode. Keys that do not work in the Full Auto mode • Focus (Auto/Manual) button (forced Auto) • Exposure (AE/AE Shift) button (forced Auto) • Multi switch • Digital effects (ON/OFF) button (forced OFF) Relationship between Program AE mode (in tape recording) and various shooting functions Program AE Mode Item Recording medium Forced ON ● Shutter speed setting × ● AE Shift × ● Image stabilizer ON/OFF Forced ON ● White balance setting Forced Auto ● Wind screen ON/OFF ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Digital zoom ON/OFF ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Forced OFF ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × Autofocus ON/OFF 16:9 ON/OFF Digital fader ON/OFF ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × × × ● ● × × × × × × × ● × × × ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Forced OFF Forced OFF Forced OFF Digital effects ON/OFF × ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Multi-screen ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × × × Photo shooting (recorded to tape) ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × Progressive photo shooting ● ● ● ● ● ● ● × × × Card mix * × ● ● ● ● ● ● × × × * : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A only Super Night mode is limited to the ZR70 MC A. 7-2 On Screen • Turn ON/OFF of the On-screen function is performed through the infrared remote controller or from the menu. • The default setting is ON in Camera mode, and OFF in VCR mode. 1-70 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-3 Headphones and Speaker • In Camera mode and Camera/Card mode, the speaker is OFF. • The speakers are on during normal card playback in the VCR mode. The Multi switch is used to adjust the volume. • Headphone volume can only be controlled when headphones are selected in the menu. The volume is controlled using the Multi switch. • The speaker is OFF when headphones are selected in the menu. 7-4 Battery Indicator, Low-Power Warning, and Low-Power Shutoff Battery Indicator • When a battery is used, the battery indicator is displayed at one of five levels (100%, 75%, 50%, 25%, 0% (approximate)). These levels indicate the amount of power remaining before the low-power warning indicator appears. The battery indicator is reset when the power is turned off. Thus if the voltage is restored while the power is off, the battery indicator level may increase when the power is turned back on. However, if the low-power warning appears, it will still be displayed even if the voltage is restored when the power is turned on and off. • When an AC adapter is used, the battery indicator is not displayed. However, the low-power warning is displayed if the voltage drops below the low-power warning level due to an abnormality. When the voltage is restored above the low-power warning level, the low-power warning disappears. • The low-power warning is displayed when the battery terminal voltage falls to approx. 6.3 V or less (for this product). 7-5 System Data Displays Camera Mode Data code (timestamp) Data code (camera data) Time code Audio mode (12/16 bit) Wide/Normal CGMS (warning) SP/LP VCR Mode PB Camera Screen REC Search DIF Input Blue Background × × ● × × ● × --× F - - - etc. ● ● ● ● ● 4-second display ● Setting display × × × --× F - - - etc. ● Main unit ● DIF side ● DIF side ● DIF side ● Setting display × ● × ● × ● ● Setting display ● ● Setting display × ● ● (including Superb Playback) * The time code display reads “-.- -:- -:- -” when no tape is inserted or when the camcorder is at an unrecorded tape position. * CGMS : If the data is copy-protected, it is not output to LINE OUT or the CVF (panel). 7-6 Data Code Display Data codes can be used to turn the display ON/OFF independently (i.e., regardless of the ON/OFF status of other On Screen character displays). 7-7 MP Tape Support LP recording onto MP tape is not possible. When a tape is loaded with LP selected on the menu, the setting is automatically switched to SP. During playback, the tape is played in LP if it was recorded in LP. 1-71 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-8 Confirmation Beep In the following cases, beep melodically. Mode Sound Power ON PIP When tape with erase protection is loaded (Camera mode) BEEP BEEP BEEP When EJECT cover is opened all the way (even when power is OFF) PIP PIP When recording is started (Camera mode) PIP When recording is paused (Camera mode) PIP PIP When Photo button is half-pressed PIP PIP When photo recording starts PIP When a condensation or a mechanical error occurs, or five seconds BEEP (5 times) before the REC PAUSE(*) five-minute timer ends When the SET button is pressed on an unavailable menu item BOOP 10, 15, and 20 seconds before the REC PAUSE (*) five-minute timer ends BIP BIP BIP Self timer (synchronized with tally blinking) PIP PIP (8 times at every second) PIP (8 times at 0.25 second) REC PAUSE (*) includes REC PAUSE for audio dubbing and AV Insert. * PIP: 4 kHz, BIP: 2 kHz, BOOP: 1kHz * The startup shutter, start/stop, and self-timer setting can be changed from the My Camera setting screen. 1-72 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-9 Using Analog Line Recording and DV Recording (1) Move the power switch to the VCR position and the Tape/Card switch to the TAPE. If a cassette has been inserted it will be stopped. The terminal (DV, S, AV) are set to output. In addition, the headphone terminal (if that setting is selected from the menu), which also serves as the AV jack, and the speaker are set to output (the headphone status takes priority). (2) Connect a cable from a recording source to the S-VIDEO terminal (video signal) and AV terminal (audio signal), or to the AV terminals (video and audio signals), or to the DV terminal. Power on the recording source. * If recording is paused while input is being received from terminals other than the DV terminal, the AV jack is automatically set as the AV input terminal. If more than one of the above terminals is connected at the same time, the active terminal is selected automatically according to the following order of priority. Order of priority : DV terminal > S terminal > AV terminal Note that when the playback screen is displayed (including Superb Playback), the playback screen takes priority. (3) Press [REC STANDBY] on the remote control. Recording is paused. If analog line input is being used, the S terminal and AV terminal are switched to input at this time. (4) To start recording, press [ / ] on the remote control. This starts recording of video, audio etc. through the terminal selected in step (2) (Press [ / ] to toggle between recording and pausing.) (5) Press [■] to stop recording. Recording is stopped. * If DV input disappears during DV recording, then recording is stopped. * If a recording source is input to the DV terminal during analog line recording, recording is continued without change. When recording is paused, the input is switched to DV input. * CGMS (Copy Generation Management System; copy protection) input signal • Only input signals (CGMS = 00) that are not copy-protected can be recorded. • If a copy-prohibited input signal (CGMS = 11) or single-copy-allowed input signal (CGMS = 10) is detected during recording or when recording is paused, then recording is paused. • Blue background is output to the LCD panel and CVF. The speaker and headphone output is muted. • Both audio and video CGMSD (Copy Generation Management System for Digital) signals are detected during DV input. The signal with the stronger copy protection setting is used. The Following Table Summarizes the Input and Output Statuses in Different Modes. DV input signal present No DV input signal LCD, CVF DV terminal S, AV terminals LCD, CVF DV terminal S, AV terminals Playback screen OUT OUT Playback screen OUT OUT No tape, STOP, FF, REW DV input screen IN OUT Blue background OUT OUT REC PAUSE, REC DV input screen IN OUT Line input screen* IN IN Playback (including Superb Playback) * : No signal if there is no LINE input. 1-73 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-10 Support for Analog Signal I/O Copyright Protection Signals (1) Detection of copyright protection signals added to input signals • Detected copyright protection signals: Pseudo-synch pulses and CGMSA (Copy Generation Management System for analog) signals • Signal detection time: 20 seconds maximum (2) Copyright protection signals added to output signals • Macrovision (pseudo-synch pulses): Not added • CGMSA signals: Not added 7-11 Video ID1 Detection/Output Support (1) S1 signal output When a Full mode (squeezed) video signal, consisting of 16:9 video compressed to 4:3, is output from the S terminal, an S 1 compatible wide monitor will detect an identification signal for automatically restoring the 16:9 video (e.g., during playback of a tape recorded in Camera 16:9 mode or a tape containing system data related to the aspect ratio). • NTSC → 16:9 Full mode + 4:3 Letter Box mode identification signal output • PAL → 16:9 Full mode identification signal output (2) Video ID1 output • When a Full mode (squeezed) video signal, consisting of 16:9 video compressed to 4:3, is output from the composite video terminal or S terminal, a video ID 1 /-compatible wide monitor will detect an identification signal for automatically restoring the 16:9 video (e.g., during playback of a tape recorded in Camera 16:9 mode or a tape containing system data related to the aspect ratio). (3) Detection of S1 signal or video ID1 during line input (ID1 is for NTSC models only) • A video ID 1 /S 1 signal multiplexed onto a video signal input from the composite video terminal or S terminal is detected, and system data relating to aspect ratio information is recorded. (4) Detection of WSS (Wide Screen Signaling) signal during line input (iPAL model only) 1-74 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-12 Audio Dubbing 7-12-1 Tapes to which Audio Dubbing can be Added Audio dubbing can only be added to tapes with 1 2-bit/SP recording (other than 4-channel simultaneous recording). The camcorder switches to Stop mode if audio dubbing is attempted on other tapes. The camcorder switches to Stop mode (a warning is displayed) if LP mode is detected, or if any of the following are detected: 1 6bit mode, 4-channel simultaneous recording, no recording, SDL recording. 7-12-2 Selecting an Audio Dubbing Signal Input Source Select an audio dubbing input source on the VCR menu. (There is no menu on PAL models. The microphone is the only audio dubbing input source for these models.) There are two audio dubbing options: “Line (AV terminal)” and “Microphone”. If Microphone is selected and an external microphone is connected, then the external microphone is used as input. If no external microphone is connected, then the built-in microphone is used as input. The settings for line video output are as follows. (1) When AV terminal input is used: The S terminal and AV terminal are set to Input mode. The speaker output can be monitored. (2) When external microphone input is used : The S terminal and AV terminal are set to Output mode. The speaker is off and line monitoring is possible. (3) When built-in microphone input is used : The S terminal and AV terminal are set to Output. The speaker is off and line motion is possible. 7-12-3 Audio Dubbing Procedure (1) In VCR mode, play and pause the tape at the position where you want to add audio dubbing. Next, press the [Audio dubbing] button on the remote control. The camcorder switches to Audio Dubbing mode (Audio Dubbing pause), and (Audio Dubbing pause) is displayed on the LCD panel (CVF). (2) Push the Pause [ ] button and input the audio through the microphone, etc. This starts the audio dubbing process. (3) When you want to stop, press the Stop [■] button. Audio Dubbing mode ends and the Audio Dubbing display disappears. The camcorder is stopped. • You can press the Pause [ ] button instead of the Stop [■] button to return to the condition in step (1) (Audio Dubbing pause) without exiting Audio Dubbing mode. • Another way to exit Audio Dubbing mode is to press the [Audio Dubbing] button during Audio Dubbing pause. • If the [Zero Set Memory] button on the remote control is pressed in advance at the tape position where you want audio dubbing to end, then after step (2), the camcorder will automatically stop at the set position and audio dubbing will end. 7-12-4 CGMS • A CGMSA signal added to an analog-input video signal cannot be detected while a tape is being played. During audio dubbing, the yellow video terminal must be disconnected. • Do not activate Audio Dubbing mode at copy-protected locations on a copy-protected tape. When the tape moves from a copyable area to a copy-protected area, the camcorder stops. 1-75 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-13 AV Insert (Not available on PAL Models) In AV Insert mode, an ITI (Insert and Track Information) area is kept and audio, video, and sub-codes are overwritten. 7-13-1 Tapes Allowing AV Insert Only tapes with SP recording can be used with AV Insert mode. If an attempt is made to enter AV Insert mode with any other type of tape, the camcorder switches to Stop mode. The camcorder stops (and displays a warning) if LP mode is detected, or if no recording SDL is detected. 7-13-2 AV Insert Signal Input Source Selection The input source is selected automatically according to the following order of priority: DV terminal (ACK detected) > AV terminal detected > No connection The settings for line video output are as follows. (1) When DV terminal input is used : The S terminal and AV terminal are set to Output mode. The speaker output can be monitored. (2) When AV terminal input is used : The S terminal and AV terminal are set to Input mode. The speaker output can be monitored. (3) When there is no connection : The S terminal and AV terminal are OFF. The speaker output is muted. 7-13-3 AV Insert Procedure (1) In VCR mode, play and pause the tape at the position where you want to insert AV. Next, press the [AV Insert] button on the remote control. The camcorder switches to AV Insert mode (AV Insert pause), and “ ” (AV Insert pause) is displayed on the LCD panel (CVF). (2) Push the Pause [ ] button and input the video and audio. This starts the AV insertion process. ● (AV Insert) is displayed on the LCD panel (CVF). (3) When you want to stop, press the Stop [■] button. AV Insert mode ends and the AV Insert display disappears. The camcorder is stopped. • You can press the Pause [ ] button instead of the Stop [■] button to return to the condition in step (1) (AV Insert pause) without exiting AV Insert mode. • Another way to exit AV Insert mode is to press the [AV Insert] button on the remote control during AV Insert pause. • If the [Zero Set Memory] button on the remote control is pressed in advance at the tape position where you want AV insertion to end, then after step (2), the camcorder will automatically stop at the set position and AV insertion will end. 7-13-4 CGMS • AV insertion for both DV input and analog input is only possible when there is no copy protection (CGMS = 00). • If a value other than “00” is detected for CGMS, then the camcorder changes to Stop mode. 1-76 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION OF PRODUCT 7-14 Analog/Digital Signal Conversion This function can be used as an A/D conversion function for inputting an analog AV signal from an analog device to a PC. 7-14-1 A/D Signal Conversion Pocedure (1) Connect the output terminal of the analog device with the analog terminal of the camcorder using STV-250N (or using S-1 50 if necessary). Also connect the DV terminal of the camcorder with the DV terminal on the PC using CV-250F or CV-1 50F. (2) Move the camcorder's power switch to [VCR] and move the Tape/Card switch to “Tape”, setting the operating mode to Stop mode without inserting a tape. (3) Select this function (A/D signal conversion) from the VCR setting item on the menu. Specifically, set “AV input → DV output” to “ON”. (4) Open the motion video acquisition software program on the PC and output the analog AV signal from the analog device. The analog AV signal from the analog device is converted by the camcorder to a digital signal (DV signal). The PC can then acquire the video and audio from the analog device, making it possible to record motion video and still images as needed. 7-14-2 CGMS • A/D signal conversion for both DV input and analog input is only possible when there is no copy protection (CGMS = 00). • If a value other than “00” is detected for CGMS, then the A/D signal conversion function is closed, the LCD panel/CVF changes to blue background, the audio output is muted, and the following warning message is displayed: “COPYRIGHT PROTECTED DUBBING RESTRICTED”. 7-15 Multi Switch VCR operations and various settings can be performed in this mode. When the Switch is Turned Multi-switch Mode Operated Function When switch is turned upward During menu selection Item selection The cursor moves up. Menu During LCD brightness adjustment Brightness adjustment The LCD screen grows brighter. During card mix level adjustment Mix level adjustment The mix level range becomes smaller. (ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) During AE shift AE level correction The iris value is increased. During manual focus Focus adjustment The focus moves closer. During VCR mode Speaker/headphone volume adjustment The volume increases. During playback zoom Movement of display frame Frame moves up (to the right). When Setting Switch is Pushed Multi switch mode Shooting pause Operated function Open/close Program AE menu When Setting switch is pushed Program AE mode selection. (sets selected settings) In Digital Effects mode Digital Effects mode selection switch Digital Effects mode is selected. When menu is displayed Menu item setting switch The item is selected. Toggles direction of frame movement The direction of frame movement is selected. During playback zoom (left-right/up-down) 1-77 CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION CONTENTS 1. P.C.B. Functions ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-1 2. Power Supply Circuit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-3 2-1 Startup of Power Supply ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-3 2-2 Power Fuses ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-5 2-3 Power Supply Circuits ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-6 3. Built-in Charger Circuit ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-7 3-1 Outline ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-7 3-2 Operation at Charging ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-8 3-2-1 Conditions To Start Charging --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-8 3-2-2 Progress of Charging ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-9 4. Signal Processing Circuit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-10 4-1 Outline of Signal Processing Circuit ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-10 4-2 Camera/Card Signal Processing ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-11 4-2-1 Camera Motion Picture Recording ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-11 4-2-2 Card Still Picture Recording --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-11 4-2-3 Card Motion Picture Recording ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-12 4-3 Recorder Signal Processing --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-13 4-4 Audio Signal Flow ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-14 5. System Control, Servo ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-15 5-1 Outline of System Control, Servo -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-15 5-2 Major Functions of Each Microcomputer ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-16 5-3 Servo Control ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-17 5-4 Personal Computer Connection Mode (USB) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-18 5-5 Error Detection ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-19 5-5-1 Error Detecting Conditions ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-19 5-5-2 Processing after Error Detection ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-19 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 1. P.C.B. Functions (1) MAIN P.C.B. System-Control Section • IC100 • IC200 MODE MI-COM BACK UP • IC103 RESET Camera/Card Section • IC1101 • IC1102 PM Section • IC1802 System control MODE MI-COM resetting Detects a DC JACK voltage to the MODE MI-COM. SDRAM MACS Memory for MACS (64M) Camera digital signal processing, and card image processing OPE AMP Operational amplifier for charge circuit • IC3201 • IC3202 DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL 2.7V REGULATOR Power PWM regulator controller 2.7V regulator • IC3203 • IC3204 4.7V REGULATOR 2.5V REGULATOR 4.7V regulator 2.5V regulator VRP2 Record playback head amplifier • IC2100 • IC2300 VIF2 FLASH Analog video input/output signal processing Memory for FR MI-COM • IC2301 VIC3 Digital VCR signal processing LSI, IEEE1394 interface, FR MI-COM, and USB interface Video Section • IC2000 • IC2302 SDRAM MO Driver Section • IC300 • IC301 Audio Section • IC801 OPE AMP MOTOR DRIVE Memory for VIC3 (64M) Operational amplifier for reel sensor Drum, capstan, and loading motor driver AUDIO INTERFACE Analog input/output signal processing SP DRIVER 4V REGULATOR Speaker amplifier 4V regulator (for speaker amplifier) V-DRIVER CCD V driver • IC1002 • IC1202 TG/CDS/AGC/AD IRIS DRIVE CCD, TG, CCD output signal sampling, AGC, and A/D converter IRIS driver, and gyro output amp • IC1701 CVF Section MOTOR DRIVER Zoom, focus motor driver EVF DRIVER EEPROM EVF LCD (CVF) drive EEPROM for CVF data, MODE MI-COM CCD CCD image sensor • IC901 • IC902 EEPROM SERI/PARA CONVERTER EEPROM for LCD data LCD power switchover • IC903 • IC4201 LCD DRIVE DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL LCD signal processing and drive Backlight drive • IC802 • IC803 (2) CAC P.C.B. Camera Section • IC1001 • IC1501 • IC1502 (3) CCD P.C.B. • IC1070 (4) LCD P.C.B. 2-1 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION (5) CVF P.C.B. Signal transfer from CAC P.C.B. to CVF-LCD, back-light LED turn-on. (6) JACK P.C.B. AV, MIC, S JACK, USB interface, Remoto control signal receiver sensor, white LED. • IC1601 P SENSOR GYRO Pitch-direction angular speed detection • IC1602 Y SENSOR GYRO Yaw-direction angular speed detection 2-2 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 2. Power Supply Circuit <Outline> In this product, a novel type of power supply system including a compact adapter (CA-570) is adopted for enhancement of cost performance and power savings. In comparison with the conventional products, this machine provides the following advantageous features: • When the DC jack is disconnected from the battery with power turned ON, poser goes OFF once. • The internal battery is charged only when the MAIN switch is at the P OFF position. • When the DC jack not connected with power source (not supplied with power) is inserted into the main unit, power is not turned on even if the battery is mounted. “A changeover of main power to the battery is not made since an event of DC jack mechanism detection takes precedence.” 2-1 Startup of Power Supply Card P.C.B. 12 CN4001 MAIN P.C.B. 21 EJ SW LITHIUM BATTERY DMC-III CASSETTE IN SW JACK CN2101 31 CN100 CN303 12 POWER SW CN101 9 10 CN3201 DC+ 2 DC J SW 3 3 13 EJECT SW 66 3V REG. 14 E3V 18 E3 DET CAS IN 67 14 DET 4 SW 12 97 RESET 11 10 RESET 2.6V DET. 2 25 LI DET IC102 BACK UP 5 6 VTR 76 POWER SW CAMERA 77 POWER SW IC100 MODE MI-COM. 73 UNREG DET 7 CN3202 BATT+ VCC 71 DC J DET DVDD 3V 5 62 52 VTR ON 41 IC103 RESET 4 VTR ON PM SECTION Fig. 2-1 2-3 SERIAL DATA IC2301 FR MI-COM. (VIC3) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION • Backup Lithium Battery LI3V power from the lithium battery is input to pin 3 of the IC102, and it is output from pin 12 as power to the MODE microcomputer. Thus, the MODE microcomputer performs data backup and clock operation when main power supply is not connected. When the voltage of the lithium battery decreases below 2.6 V (or when the lithium battery is not loaded), the IC102 outputs the “L” signal form pin 2. Upon receipt of this signal at the time of power-on, the MODE microcomputer sends it to the FR microcomputer, which then issue a lithium battery low-level warning indication. • Main Power Supply Main power (DC-JACK/BATTERY) is supplied to pin 13 of IC102. Through the internal regulator in IC102, the main power thus supplied is converted to 3V power, which is output as E3V from pin 14 of IC102. Furthermore, through the internal switch, the main power is converted to LI3V, which is output from pin 12 of IC102 as a power voltage for driving the MODE MI-COM. Supplied with the main power, IC102 outputs the “L” signal from its pin 4. When the MODE MI-COM receives the “L” signal and the two signals output from pin 4 of IC103, it recognizes that the power supply is loaded. Then the MODE MI-COM performs initialization to set up a standby state. In this state, the MODE MI-COM carries out detection of start-related switch signals. Upon detection of these switch signals, the MODE MI-COM delivers the VTR ON(H) signal from its pins 52. When the VTR ON(H)signal is output, each circuit power is made active. When each circuit power is made active, 3V power is input to pins 5/7 of IC102. 3V power is output as the power for the MODE MI-COM from pin 12 of IC102 to save its power consumption. 2-4 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 2-2 Power Fuses MAIN P.C.B. CN3201 2 FU3201 UNREG 1 DC + FU3203 MECHA UNREG FU3204 DC/DC UNREG MODE MI-COM FU3205 SHOE UNREG FU3202 * ZR70MC A Only P5 + VTR UNREG CN3202 5,6 FU1801 MICOM UNREG BATT + Fig. 2-2 The power supply from the battery DC JACK is supplied to six fuses on the MAIN P.C.B., through which the following six power voltage are delivered. (1) UNREG 1 : FU3201 • 3V power source (LCD3V, A 3V, HA 3V, DVDD 3V, IRIS 3V, CAM 3V) • 2.7V power source (SDRAM 2.7V, AVDD 2.7V, DIF 2.7V) • 2.5V power source (DVDD 2.5V) • 1.4V power source (DVDD 1.4V, MACS 1.4V, AVDD 1.4V) • LCD drive power source (-8V, 8.5V, 15V) • CCD drive power source (-7V, +15V) (2) P5/VTR UNREG : FU3202 • 4.7V power source (AA 4.7V, VIF 4.7V, HA 4.7V) • 5V power source (POW 5V, LCD 5V) • VCR UNREG (3) MECHA UNREG : FU3203 • DRUM /CAPSTAN (4) DC/DC UNREG : FU3204 • DC/DC CONVERTER (5) SHOE UNREG : FU3205 • Accessory shoe power source (6) MI-COM UNREG : FU1801 • MI-COM UNREG (BATTERY) 2-5 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 2-3 Power Supply Circuits Figure 2-3 shows the power supply circuits. The ON/OFF condition of each power supply voltage is controlled by the VTR ON signals output from the MODE MI-COM. MAIN P.C.B. 46 PWM 50 CH-1 UNREG REG. Q3204 LPF MACS 1.4V LPF AVDD 1.4V LPF DVDD 1.4V IC3204 40 UNREG REG. DVDD 2.5V IC3202 PWM IC3201 DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL 56 CH-3 REG. Q3205 37 REG. UNREG IC3203 PWM 57 CH-4 REG. REG. Q3206 21 LPF SDRAM 2.7V LPF AVDD 2.7V LPF DIF 2.7V LPF DVDD 3V LPF IRIS 3V LPF CAM 3V LPF LCD 3V LPF A 3V LPF HA 3V LPF AA 4.7V LPF VIF 4.7V LPF HA 4.7V UNREG P 5V LPF PWM 60 CH-5 15 PWM 61 CH-6 UNREG VTR ON 28 62 CAP VM REG. Q3208 11 PWM UNREG REG. CH-7 30 5 64 LPF LCD 15V LPF LCD 8.5V LPF LCD -10V LPF CCD 15V LPF CCD -7V UNREG 31 PWM LCD 5V DRUM VM REG. Q3207 REG. CH-8 Fig. 2-3 2-6 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 3. Built-in Charger Circuit DC P.C.B. MAIN P.C.B. DC JACK DET CN3201 DC J SW 2 DC+ 1 DC- IC103 RESET UNREG DET JACK 3 73 Q1805 Q1803 Q1804 INIT CHG2 INIT CHG1 DC JACK DET DC 71 100 87 99 IC100 MODE MI-COM. Q1802 CHAGE A/D I 41 90 89 CN3202 5,6 BATT+ 3,4 BATT- 2 BATT INFO AD 1 BATT E3 D BATT E3 B Fig. 2-4 3-1 Outline The main circuit elements and their functions are as follows. (1) IC100 : MODE MI-COM • Charging voltage and charging current control • Detection and display of charging progress • Error discrimination and display • Battery type discrimination and DC jack input detection (2) IC 1802 : OPE AMP • Signal amplification for detecting charging current (3) Q1802/Q1803 : MOS form FET • Power supply changeover switch (4) Q1804/Q1805 : TRANSISTOR • Trickle charge switch 2-7 88 BATT INFO AD BATTERY A/D V IC1802 BATT AD ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 3-2 Operation at Charging 3-2-1 Conditions To Start Charging When the following conditions are satisfied, the MODE MI-COM (IC100) to start charging. Conditions Detection Source of detection Main unit power is turned OFF. Battery is installed. MODE MI-COM pin 76/77 MODE MI-COM pin 88 POWER SW Battery D terminal DC JACK is inserted. (BATT INFO AD) MODE MI-COM pin 71 (CN3202 pin 2) DC JACK (CN3201 pin 3) DC JACK input voltage is 8.4±0.3V. (DC JACK DET) MODE MI-COM pin 87 (BATT AD) MODE MI-COM pin 73 DC JACK (CN3201 pin 2) (UNREG DET) 2-8 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 3-2-2 Progress of Charging When the conditions described in 3-2-1 are satisfied, the MODE MI-COM starts charging according to the specifications in Fig.2-5. The charging current in quick charge can be restricted by CA-570. * Charging is allowed to start provided that the UNREG voltage is 8.4 0.3V before starting the charging. Otherwise, an error is indicated. * Charging can be performed provided that the power is turned OFF. * If the DC JACK is detected, the charging is turned OFF when the power is turned ON (no power supplied from the battery). Charging current LED flashes once Quick charge 1.525A LED lights up steadily Up to battery installed/removed and power turned ON LED flashes twice 0.075A 1.1A ADI detection voltage = 1.706V When battery voltage becomes 6.5V, quick charge starts. If the battery is not installed/removed after completion of charge, charging does not start unless the battery voltage becomes 7V or lower. * An error is indicated and charging is turned OFF if the battery voltage becomes 6.4V or lower during charging other than trickles 1 and 2. * An error is indicated and charging is turned OFF if the battery voltage becomes 5V or lower during charging trickle 2. * An error is indicated and charging is turned OFF if the charging voltage is 1.8A or higher (detected voltage > 2.7V). * Charging is turned OFF if the charging current is 70mA or lower. Specified from D65 BP-Z: 10 min. BP-2Z: 10 min. If the battery voltage BP-3Z: 10 min. becomes 5.2V, 100mA the trickle 2 starts. ADI detection voltage 350mA max. = 0.155V Trickle 1 50mA max. 70mA ADI detection voltage = 0.109V Lapsed time Charge ended TOTAL TIMER BATT V 5.2V INIT-CHG1 ON INIT-CHG2 OFF CHG OFF BATT V 6.5V ADI detection voltage 1.706V INIT-CHG1 OFF INIT-CHG2 OFF CHG ON BATT V 6.5V 0.155V ADI detection voltage 1.706V INIT-CHG1 OFF INIT-CHG2 OFF CHG ON Torque 1 timer 110 min. max. Error indicated and charging OFF at timeout Quick charge timer Error indicated and charging OFF at timeout 2-flash timer LED lit and charging ended at timeout BP-Z : 2Hmax BP-2Z : 4Hmax BP-3Z : 5Hmax BP-Z : 2Hmax BP-2Z : 4Hmax BP-3Z : 8Hmax BATT V 8.0V 0.109V ADI detection voltage INIT-CHG1 OFF INIT-CHG2 OFF CHG ON 5.2V BATT V 6.5V INIT-CHG1 ON INIT-CHG2 ON CHG OFF Torque 2 timer 100 min. max. Error indicated and charging OFF at timeout BATT V 8.0V ADI detection voltage 0.109V INIT-CHG1 OFF INIT-CHG2 OFF CHG OFF Total timer LED lit and charging ended at timeout Supplementary timer LED lit and charging ended at timeout BP-Z : 6Hmax BP-2Z : 9Hmax BP-3Z : 12Hmax BP-Z : 1Hmax BP-2Z : 1Hmax BP-3Z : 1Hmax Fig. 2-5 2-9 0.155V ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 4. Signal Processing Circuit 4-1 Outline of Signal Processing Circuit Figure 2-6 shows the entire block diagram of the signal processing circuit and the flow of video and audio signals. CCD P.C.B. LENS IC1001 CCD CAC P.C.B. IC1002 TG/CDS/AGC/AD MEMORY CARD IC501 EVF DRIVE CVF LCD LCD P.C.B. MAIN P.C.B. IC1101 SDRAM IC1102 MACS CARD P.C.B. IC2301 VIC3 JACK P.C.B. MIN AV JACK IC903 EVF DRIVE IC2303 SDRAM LCD IC2100 VIF2 USB TERMINAL USB IC801 AIF3 MIC DV TERMINAL DIF IC802 SP DRIVE FR MICOM IC2000 VRP2 REC/PB HEAD SPEAKER Fig. 2-6 2-10 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 4-2 Camera/Card Signal Processing 4-2-1 Camera Motion Picture Recording 64 Mbit SDRAM IC1101 32 bit SDRAM IF CDS/ AGC/ AD/TG IC1002 CCD IC1001 proc 36MHz resize nr Deformation, Drawing REND Synthesis COMP JPEG JPEG CARD IF Camera signal processing GRAB 10bit 18MHz AIF IC801 VIC3 IC2301 FR MI-COM Audio IC1102 Fig. 2-7 4-2-2 Card Still Picture Recording 64 Mbit SDRAM IC1101 32 bit SDRAM IF RAW CDS/ AGC/ AD/TG IC1002 CCD IC1001 36MHz 10bit 18MHz proc YCC 1 resize FR MI-COM DMA YCC 2 Deformation, Drawing REND nr Camera signal processing GRAB AIF IC801 JPEG Synthesis COMP CARD IF Audio USB IC1102 Fig. 2-8 2-11 VIC3 IC2301 SD CARD ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 4-2-3 Card Motion Picture Recording 64 Mbit SDRAM IC1101 32 bit SDRAM IF YCC 1 CDS/ AGC/ AD/TG IC1002 CCD IC1001 proc FR MI-COM YCC 2 resize Deformation, Drawing REND nr Camera signal processing GRAB 10bit 18MHz 36MHz DMA AIF IC801 JPEG Synthesis COMP CARD IF VIC3 IC2301 SD CARD Audio IC1102 Fig. 2-9 <CCD> IC1001 • 1/6 inches interlaced CCD • Complementary color filter • Total number of pixels Approx. 680,000 Effective number of pixels Tape : Approx. 340,000 / Card : Approx. 447,000 <CDS/AGC/AD/TG> IC1002 A signal read out of the CCD is extracted. Then, after the extracted signal is subjected to AGC processing and A/D conversion, it is output as a digital signal. <MACS> IC1102 Various camera signal processing operations (EIS, AWB, etc.) and digital effect processing operation are carried out. This circuit carries out various camera signal processing operations (EIS, AWB, etc.), and digital effect processing. It also performs multimedia-application signal processing mainly for still image recording. • Feature engine • High-speed card interface • JPEG • Audio data compression (ADPCM) • USB 1.1 function <SDRAM> IC1101 Field memory for camera signal processing and digital effect processing Image data memory for Memory card write/read operation 2-12 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 4-3 Recorder Signal Processing VIC BLOCK DIF BLOCK IC2303 SDRAM SDRAM INTERFACE DIF INTERFACE DV TERMINAL VIDEO HEAD A DATA IC1102 B DATA MACS IC2100 VIF2 VIDEO INTERFACE D/A A/D COMPRESSION /DEMOD. BUS ECC REC/PB PROCESS IC2000 VRP2 AUDIO INTERFACE IC801 AIF3 AV JACK AV JACK S TERMINAL CVF LCD R,G,B LCD MI-COM. BLOCK FR MI-COM. USB BLOCK USB INTERFACE IC2301 VIC3 USB TERMINAL Fig. 2-10 < VIC3 >IC2301 • The VIC, MI-COM, DIF INTERFACE and USB INTERFACE circuits are integrated on a single semiconductor chip. • A/B DATA : Input in camera mode. B DATA is output and A DATA is input at playback. (MACS digital effect circuit is used at playback.) The video data and signals input to VIC3 are subjected to digital VCR format signal processing. Audio data, subcode data and ITI data are also created at VIC3, and these signals are output to VRP2 as 41.85 Mbps data of • DIF DV format. : After conversion to digital data conforming to IEEE1394 standard, the data is output at DV terminal. At digital input, the data enters VIC3 signal processing circuit via the opposite route. < VRP2 >IC2000 Recording data of 41.85 Mbps output from VIC3 is amplified at VRP2, and is recorded on magnetic tape while undergoing head switching of CH-1, CH-2 with a switching pulse. At playback, the head output signal is amplified and sent to VIC3. < VIF2 >IC2100 Y and C signals sent from VIC3 are output as Y, C signals for S terminal and composite video. At line input, input signals undergo level adjustment, sync signal separation and are output to VIC3. 2-13 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 4-4 Audio Signal Flow L MIC HEAD PHONE AV JACK EXT MIC R R L R IC2301 VIC3 IC1102 MACS L IC801 AIF3 MEM IF CARD IF SDRAM CARD L IC2000 VRP2 REC/ PB HEAD R BEEP FR MI-COM. L+R + − IC802 SPEAKER DRIVER FR MI-COM. BEEP SPEAKER Fig. 2-11 < AIF >IC801 Carries out switching between internal and external microphones (by means of serial data from MODE MI-COM),plus ALC (Auto Level Control), fading, and amplification of various output signals. For the beep tone issued at ejection, etc., the signal from the FR MI-COM is generated in the circuit and changed over in the AIF. The microphone amplifier, HPF, ALC, A/D, D/A, and digital I/F circuits are contained in this IC. It is also used for changeover between ordinary voice sound and beep sound. < SPEAKER DRIVER >IC802 This integrated circuit is used for speaker drive operation. 2-14 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 5. System Control, Servo 5-1 Outline of System Control, Servo Figure 2-12 shows the overall configuration of the system control & servo circuit, plus the flow of data. System control is performed by the FR MI-COM (IC2301) and MODE MI-COM (IC100) on MAIN P.C.B. MAIN P.C.B. MEMORY CARD IC3201 DC/DC CONVERTER IC1102 MACS DRUM D-VS DRUM C-VS M DRIVER FG/PG PWM C PWM D CAPSTAN DFG/PG VIC CFG M FG ZOOM SW IC301 MOTOR DRIVER JACK P.C.B. LOADING DRIVER REMOTE CONTROL SIGNAL RECEIVER DIAL SW CAPSTAN DRIVER IC2300 FLASH FR MI-COM CARD P.C.B. IC2000 VRP2 LOADING M DMC III MODE SW C.DOWN SW BOT/EOT SENS. DEW REEL FG IC2301 VIC3 R-KEY HEAD START/STOP SW IC2100 VIF2 PHOTO SW IC801 AIF3 MIC IC100 MODE MI-COM POWER SW LCD P.C.B. EJECT SW IC902 SERI/PARA CONVERTER LENS EEPROM IC901 EEPROM IC1501 EVF DRIVER IC903 LCD DRIVER IC101 IC1701 MOTOR DRIVER IC1002 CDS AGC A/D TG IC1202 IRIS DRIVE Fig. 2-12 2-15 CAC P.C.B. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 5-2 Major Functions of Each Microcomputer (1) FR MI-COM (IC2301 : VIC3) The FR MI-COM, as the nucleus of the system, carries out control of mode transition plus mechanism control through communication with MODE MI-COM. It also detects of various sensors and switches (DMCIII). Following are the major functions. • VIC (Video) VIF2 (Video Interface) control / AIF3 (Audio Interface) controls / DIF (Digital Interface) controls • Control in accordance with IEEE1394 • USB interface control • DMC III mechanism control • Card control • CCD drive control • AE, AF, AWB control • EIS (Electric Image Stabilizer) control • OSD (On Screen Display) bitmap control * The FR microcomputer in this machine does not have a dedicated EEPROM. Since a flash ROM is used for the FR microcomputer as a substitute for the EEPROM, it is required to update the flash ROM after adjustment and data modification regarding the FR microcomputer. (2) MODE MI-COM (IC100) The MODE MI-COM is mainly in charge of the power-on sequence and charging control. Following are the major functions. • Key input • LCD / EVF control • Remote control input • Power ON/OFF control • Built-in charge circuit control • MIC (Memory In Cassette) control * In this machine, an EEPROM for the MODE microcomputer is mounted on the CAC P.C.B. instead of the MAIN P.C.B. 2-16 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 5-3 Servo Control Servo control is carried out by the VIC3 (VIC and FR MI-COM). The FR MI-COM is used for servo control of motor ON/OFF and rotational direction, and the VIC is used to output rotational speed and phase control signals. More specifically in terms of signal flow, the VIC detects the FG/PG and PB-RF signals from the motor, and sends the detected signal information to the FR MI-COM. Then, the FR MI-COM generates an error signal to be output to the VIC. Thereafter, the VIC outputs an error signal (PWM), which is driven on the MAIN P.C.B. for sending a control voltage to the motor driver IC. DC/DC CONVERTER CAP VS CAP VM DRUM VS DRUM VM DMC III LOAD ON/ UNLOAD FR DERR VIC3 CERR LOAD+/LOADIC1301 MO DRIVE U/V/W Ucoil/Vcoil/Wcoil LOADING MOTOR DRUM MOTOR CAPSTAN MOTOR CFG2 DA CFG DA S REEL S REEL Hall SENSOR DA T REEL T REEL Hall SENSOR Fig. 2-13 2-17 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 5-4 Personal Computer Connection Mode (USB) IC1101 SDRAM IC1102 MACS IC1001 CCD IC1002 TG/CDS AGC/AD Card camera mode of signal flow Still Picture Signal Processing FR MI-COM Personal computer connection mode of signal flow MEMORY CARD USB CONTROLER USB TERMINAL IC2301 VIC3 Fig. 2-14 In the card camera mode, an image signal produced in the camera section is sent to the memory card via the MACS. In the personal computer connection mode, the USB terminal and the memory card are connected through the USB controller. The FR MI-COM performs control of changeover between the card camera mode and the personal computer connection mode. 2-18 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 2. TECHNICAL DESCRIPTION 5-5 Error Detection If an abnormality has been occurred in any rotation drive system (drum, capstan, reel, loading), a relevant mode enters. The LCD indicates “PLEASE UNLOAD THE CASSETTE” and blinks “EJECT”. 5-5-1 Error Detecting Conditions The following table gives error detecting conditions. Kind Drum error Condition Detection Error detecting mode Starting / steady D-FG FG frequency when steady 900Hz Error detecting level Starting: Beyond 80-150%. Steady : 30% max. Error detecting time Starting : 5sec. Steady : 0.5sec. Capstan error Error detecting mode Starting / steady FG frequency when steady 1347Hz Error detecting level Starting : 80% max. C-FG Steady : 60Hz max. Error detecting time Starting : 2sec. Steady : 2sec. Reel error Error detecting mode Error detection Starting / Normal / UNLOAD T, S-REEL FG Normally : The C-FG count per reel FG cycle is C-FG Starting : M ore than 3294 Steady : M ore than 2256 UNLOAD : Reel FG half cycle is 1 sec or more (Take-up reel only for both) Loading error Error detecting mode M ode transfer Error detection M ode transfer time M ode SW STANDBY-STOP : 6sec STANDBY-POPUP : 3sec STOP-PLAY : 3sec 5-5-2 Processing after Error Detection The following table gives processing after error detection. • Pop up : Error display→error eject → pop up →error clear • Error stop : Error display→STOP position (not cleared unless EJECTED) Cassette in Loading During loading Loading completed During tape running During mode Drum error Pop up Pop up Error stop Error stop Error stop Error stop Capstan error Pop up ------- Error stop Error stop Error stop Error stop Reel error ------- ------- Error stop Error stop Error stop Error stop Loading error Pop up Pop up Error stop Error stop ------- Error stop 2-19 CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS CONTENTS 1. List of Maintenance Tools and Supplies --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-1 1-1 List of Maintenance Tools ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-1 1-2 List of Supplies ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3-1 2. Setting ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-2 2-1 Setting A -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-2 2-2 Setting B -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-3 3. Service Modes --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-4 3-1 Outline ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-4 3-2 How to Change Over to Service Mode --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-4 3-3 How to Operate Wireless Remote Controller in Service Mode ----------------------------------------------------------------- 3-5 3-4 Indication in Service Mode ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-6 4. Description of Service Modes --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-7 4-1 Error Rate ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3-7 4-2 Mechanical Error Indication --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-8 4-2-1 Mechanical Error Normal Mode ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-8 4-2-2 Mechanical Error Analysis Mode ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-9 4-3 Cleaning Mode ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-10 4-4 Commands Particular to Camera --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-10 4-5 Checking the Lens Resetting ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-11 4-6 Functional Check of Control Keys and Switches -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-11 4-6-1 MODE MI-COM Input Port --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-11 4-6-2 MODE MI-COM A/D Port ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-12 4-6-3 FR MI-COM Input Port -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-12 4-6-4 FR MI-COM A/D Port --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-12 5. Service Hints ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-13 5-1 Arrangement of Circuit Boards ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-13 5-2 Location of Main Elements --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-14 5-3 Current Consumption Check ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-16 6. Trouble Shooting ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-17 6-1 Power Supply ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-17 6-2 Camera Picture Faulty --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-18 6-3 Faulty of Playback Picture ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-19 6-4 Startup Window Setting ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-20 7. Mechanical Error Applicability Table ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3-21 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 1. List of Maintenance Tools and Supplies 1-1 List of Maintenance Tools Item Name Item Number Purpose Remarks Alignment T ape, (Color bar master/NT SC) DY9-1380-000 Recorder electrical adjustment Alignment T ape (tracking) DY9-1379-000 Running adjustment DMC III Cassette T orque Gauge for DV DY9-1346-000 Running adjustment DMC III DV Cleaning T ape (hard) DY9-1384-000 Head cleaning DMC III Driver bit for tape path adjustment DY9-2053-000 T ape path adjustment DMC III Color bar chart DY9-2002-000 Camera electrical adjustment Color Viewer 5600° K for 100V DY9-2039-100 Camera electrical adjustment (JPN) Color Viewer 5600° K for 115V DY9-2039-115 Camera electrical adjustment (USA) Lamp for Color Viewer 5600K DY9-2040-000 Replacement Filter, CCA W12ø46mm DY9-2046-000 Camera electrical adjustment CASSET T E, SERVICE MODE DY9-1386-000 Service mode, electrical adjustment NEW EXT ENSION CONNECT OR (20pin) DY9-1387-000 T est pin extended NEW 1-2 List of Supplies Item Name Grease FLOIL C-1Z Item Number Purpose DY9-3039-000 Lubrication Remarks DMC III Logenest Lambda A-74 CY9-8102-000 Lubrication Lens Grease GE-C9 CY9-8043-000 Lubrication Lens Grease FLOIL 948P DY9-3051-000 Lubrication DMC III Hanal FL-778 DY9-3026-000 Lubrication Cover Hanal KS-39M DY9-3053-000 Lubrication Cover Dia Bond No. 1663G CY9-8129-000 Adhesive LCD Sponge (W × H × T : 300mm × 200mm × 6mm) DY9-4001-000 General-purpose vibration isolating /sound absorbing material Adhesive T ape, No.354E DY9-3032-000 General-purpose adhesive tape (W × L × T : 9mm × 50m × 0.15mm, UL type) Adhesive T ape, No. 501F DY9-3034-000 General-purpose (W × L × T : 10mm × 50m × 0.16mm, UL type) Sheet, Shield (W × H : 250mm × 250mm) double-side-coated adhesive tape DY9-3036-000 General-purpose shield material 3-1 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 2. Setting (1) Adjustments other than DMC-III : Perform adjustments in the product state. (2) Tracking adjustment (DMC-III) and Envelope check : Perform them with the Setting A. (3) Adjustments related to DMC-III other than Tracking adjustment, tape path system check and tape path system cleaning : Perform them with the Setting B. 2-1 Setting A Envelope Check) (1) Detach the Lithium Battery Cover. (2) Connect the extension connector (DY9-1387-000) to CN2900. (3) Observe the PB-RF waveform output from the extension connector Extension connector (DY9-1387-000) Pin No. Signal Designation 7 GND 19 SWP 21 GND 23 PBRF DY9-1387-000 Fig. 3-1 Tracking Adjustment) (1) Remove the CASSETTE COVER referring to Fig. 3-2 (a). (2) When the posts are going to be adjusted, eject and remove the cassette once and perform the prospective adjustment as shown in Fig. 3-2 (b). (3) Repeat the observation of the PB-RF waveform and the prospective adjustment until fluctuation of envelope is re-moved. Note : When the tracking adjustment is going to be performed, refer to Chapter 2-8 on page 4-48 : Tape Path Adjustment. (a) (b) CASSETTE COVER ×2 ADJUSTMENT DRIVER ×2 Fig. 3-2 3-2 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 2-2 Setting B (1) Remove the FRONT COVER, REAR COVER, LEFT COVER UNIT, RIGHT COVER UNIT and JACK P.C.B. referring to “Chapter 4-1: Disassembling and Reassembling”. Note 1 : Referring to Fig.3-3, connect the required cables. Note 2 : Observe the signal in the same manner as that for setting A. Note 3 : For EJECT, select the service mode and use the wireless remote controller. (Note : Same manner for recorder keys) WIRELESS CONTROLLER LEFT COVER UNIT REAR COVER UNIT CN101 MONITOR TV CN3201 CA-570 CN2101 JACK P.C.B. Fig. 3-3 3-3 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 3. Service Modes 3-1 Outline (1) The service mode in this equipment uses the wireless remote controller. (To be used in remote control code 2) (2) For changeover to the service mode, a dedicated tool (CASSETTE, SERVICE MODE: DY9-1386-000) is required in addition to the wireless remote controller. (3) Mode changeover is available between the service mode and the normal mode using the “Audio dubbing” and “SLOW” keys of the wireless remote controller. As long as power is ON, the service mode is available even if the “CASSETTE, SERVICE MODE” is removed. (4) In the service mode, changeover of the main unit operation mode can be handled using the keys on the main unit and the remote control mode 1. (5) In the service mode, safety functions such as for mechanical error detection, DEW detection and low voltage detection are canceled. (6) In the service mode, the LCD mirror function is canceled. 3-2 How to Change Over to Service Mode (1) Cassette for changeover to service mode (DY9-1386-000) Set the ((CASSETTE, SERVICE MODE)) in the equipment and load the data. (2) Press the “Dubbing” key on the wireless remote controller that is set at Remote controller code 2. * To changeover to Remote controller code 2, press “Remote controller setting” and “Zoom T” keys simultaneously for 2 sec. * The remote controller code setting on the DVC main unit is operable both at remote controller codes 1 and 2. DY9-1386-000 (3) Now the changeover to the service mode has been completed and the SERVICE MODE appears on the screen. Fig. 3-4 * Pressing the “SLOW” key performs the changeover to the normal mode from the service mode. As long as the power supply is ON, the service mode is available by setting the “Audio dubbing” key even if the cassette for transfer to service mode is removed. Fig. 3-5 3-4 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 3-3 How to Operate Wireless Remote Controller in Service Mode (1) To use the wireless remote controller in the service mode, set it at Remote controller code 2. * To changeover to Remote controller code 2, press the “Remote controller setting” and “Zoom T” keys simultaneously for 2 sec. 4. SERCH + 3. START/STOP 11. PLAY 5. SEARCH - 8. FF 10. SERCH SELECT 6. FRAME + 9. REW Remote Controller Code 2 setting 12. STOP 7. FRAME - 14. × 2 1. DUBBING 2. SLOW 13. PAUSE Fig. 3-6 No. Key Designation (in Normal Mode) Key Designation (in Service Mode) Function 1 DUBBING SERVICE MODE Change over to service mode 2 SLOW NORMAL MODE Change over to normal mode 3 START/STOP CS+ Increases CS by 1. 4 SEARCH + FUNCTION + Increases FUNCTION by 1. 5 SEARCH - FUNCTION - Decreases FUNCTION by 1. 6 FRAME + HIGH ADDRESS + Increases HIGH ADDRESS by 1. 7 FRAME - HIGH ADDRESS - Decreases HIGH ADDRESS by 1. 8 FF ADDRESS + Increases ADDRESS by 1. 9 REW ADDRESS - Decreases ADDRESS by 1. 10 SEARCH SELECT MODE SELECT Change over to RD/WR mode 11 PLAY DATA + Increases DATA by 1. 12 STOP DATA - Decreases DATA by 1. 13 PAUSE STORE Defines/w rites DATA. 14 ×2 EJECT Performs EJECT. 3-5 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 3-4 Indication in Service Mode Shown below are the indications in the service mode. 4 5 18 6 8 9 1 2 3 10 7 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 Fig. 3-7 1. 2. Indicates that the service mode is currently selected. (“SERV”) MODE : Indicates the MODE currently selected. (RD/WR/ST) 3. 4. Indicates for which block the command is specified. (MA,MD, CA, CD, etc.) CS : Indicates the Chip Select currently specified. (0~F) 5. 6. Function : Indicates the Function currently selected. (00~FF) ADDR : Indicates the ADDRESS currently selected. (0000~FFFF) 7. 8. DT : Indicate, in hexadecimal representation, the DATA currently being read or set. (00~FF) Indicates the mechanical status. (POPUP, STBY, LOAD1, LOAD2, STOP, PLAY) 9. Indicates the absolute track No. 10. Indicates the mechanical error. (Main power supply backup) 11. Indicates mechanical error history (LITHIUM 3V battery backup) 12. Indicates the version of the MAIN program in the FR MI-COM. 13. Indicates the version of the MODE MI-COM. 14. Indicates the version of the CAMERA program in the FR MI-COM. 15. Indicates the version of the CARD program in the FR MI-COM. 16. E0 : Indicates the error rate of the track that is traced in the CH0 (Low ch) head. 17. E1 : Indicates the error rate of the track that is traced in the CH1 (High ch) head. 18. Data Write status (00: READ mode, 04 : Write preparation, OC : Write execution) 3-6 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4. Description of Service Modes 4-1 Error Rate <Generals> (1) A VIDEO error rate (VIDEO + AUDIO) and an AUDIO error rate can be checked. (2) Note that the error rate is worsened on occurrence of failure in tape running, deterioration of tape, decreased in head output, failure in head amplifier, improper drum shield, etc. <How to read a VIDEO error rate> An average error rate on 64-track AUDIO+VIDEO sector is indicated in exponential representation. Low ch. High ch. EO 2 5 E1 Example) ‘25’ is indicated: Error rate = 2×10 -5 2 × 10 -5 Fig. 3-8 <How to read an AUDIO error rate> To read error rate of AUDIO track, follow the procedures in the table below. Low ch. The number of erroneous sync block of 64-track AUDIO sync blocks is indicated in two hexadecimal digits. High ch. AO 2 3 A1 (FF limitation is imposed on a value exceeding 255.) 2 3 Example) ‘23’is indicated: Number of erroneous sync blocks = 35 (hexadecimal) (2 ×16)+ 3 = 35 (decimal) In the product specifications, the error rate on both channels in self -recording LP playback is as follows : Error rate =28H or less Fig. 3-9 (Number of erroneous sync blocks = 40 or less) Important After the adjustment, set the DT to the product setting . (press STORE key at 1 of STEP 1 state.) <Change to an AUDIO error rate> ST EP 1 MONIT OR PROCEDURE 1) Make setting shown at right. CS Function 0 10 Microcomputer operation ADDR MODE 001D ST DT 00 →03 Product setting 03 ↑ ↑ ↑ Remarks) Selecting DT back to "0"makes a return to Audio + Video error rate. 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) RD 3-7 Audio error rate indication ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4-2 Mechanical Error Indication <Outline> (1) On occurrence of a mechanical error, the conditions of the error can be checked in the service mode. (Normal indication mode and analysis mode available) (2) In the normal indication mode of the mechanical error, two types of indications appear on the service mode initial screen: the data indication retained only by the main battery and the error history data indication backed up by LITHIUM 3V. (3) The data backed up by the LITHIUM 3V can be reset by the STEP-1 operation shown below. (4) For changeover to the mechanical error analysis mode, perform the STEP-2 operation shown below. ST EP 1 2 MONIT OR PROCEDURE CS Function 1) Make setting shown at right. 0 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) 1) Make setting shown at right. 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) Microcomputer operation ADDR MODE DT 08 0008 ST 00 Error data held only in the POWER-ON ↑ 0 ↑ 10 ↑ 0079 RD ST ↑ 01 state is indicated. ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ Service screen change. 4-2-1 Mechanical Error Normal Mode Relevant errors are highlighted in purple. E : TAPE END B : TAPE TOP D : DRUM ERROR C : CAPSTAN ERROR S : S-REEL ERROR T : T- REEL ERROR L : LOADING MTR ERROR D : DEW ERROR Fig. 3-10 3-8 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4-2-2 Mechanical Error Analysis Mode 1. Address of the sequence that was under execution in the event of an error. (information of the control status.) 2. S reel error detection data in the event of an error. 3. T reel error detection data in the event of an error. 1 2 3 Fig. 3-11 <How to Check> By following the steps (1) through (4) shown below, the “Sequence” in which the error has occurred can be checked in addition to the type of the mechanical error. (1) First of all, check the “Sequence” that matches the data (1), referring to “Address” in the mechanical error applicability table. (2) For the applicable “Sequence” in 1 above, if S reel error detection sensitivity level (CEh or 8Dh) is listed in the “Sreel” subfield of the “Mecha Error” field, compare it with the data (2). If the data (2) is above the S reel error detection sensitivity level listed, the error history indication should be “S reel error”. (3) For the applicable “Sequence” in 1 above, if T reel error detection sensitivity level (CEh or 8Dh) is listed in the “Treel” subfield of the “Mecha Error” field, compare it with the data (3). If the data (3) is above the T reel error detection sensitivity level listed, the error history should be “T reel error”. (4) Unless S or T reel error is determined in step 2 or 3 above, the error history should be the error condition specified in the “Mechanical Error Applicablity Table” field marked with Note : . If a multiple number of items are specified, any of the applicable items should have occurred. The DEW errors can be identified according to whether or not there is dew indication at an occurrence of an error. * The reference table of actual mechanical errors is given at the end of Chapter 3. (See “7: Mechanical Error Table” on p. 3-21.) 3-9 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4-3 Cleaning Mode When cleaning the head with hard-type cleaning tape (DY9-1384-000), set up the cleaning mode according to the procedure given below. Note : ST EP 1 After head cleaning, be sure to restore the settings to normal. PROCEDURE MONIT OR Microcomputer operation CS Function ADDR MODE DT 1) Make setting shown at right. 0 10 0111 ST -- 2) Increases DT by 2. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ -- (Example: 80 → 82) 3) Perform ST ORE. (Press PAUSE key. ↑ RD ↑ ↑ 1) Change over to the normal mode and turn OFF the power supply. -- (Change bit-02 to 1 from 0.) 2 Completion of cleaning mode setup Resetting of cleaning mode 4-4 Commands Particular to Camera <Outline> (1) The commands particular to camera are provided for checking the operation. (2) Make preparation according to the table below and carry out the desired commands particular to camera. (3) To restore any setting back to the original status, press the PAUSE key (STORE) for each item again in the “ST” mode. Turning the power OFF/ON resets all the settings. ST EP WB SET MONIT OR PROCEDURE Microcomputer operation CAM SPECIAL COMMAND CS Function 1) Make setting shown at right. 2 08 3300 ST -- 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3301 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3302 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3303 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3304 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3305 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3306 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3307 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3308 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 3309 RD -- ST -- ↑ 2 ↑ 08 ↑ 330A RD -- ST -- WB 1) Make setting shown at right. LOCK 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) WB 1) Make setting shown at right. T URBO 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) WB 1) Make setting shown at right. OUT DOOR 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) WB 1) Make setting shown at right. INDOOR 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) IRIS 1) Make setting shown at right. OPEN 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) IRIS 1) Make setting shown at right. CLOSE 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) AGC 1) Make setting shown at right. MAX 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) AGC 1) Make setting shown at right. MIN 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) COLOR 1) Make setting shown at right. BAR 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) White 1) Make setting shown at right. ADDR MODE DT 100% 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) ↑ 08 ↑ 330B -- 1) Make setting shown at right. ↑ 2 RD White ST -- 50% 2) Execute ST ORE. (Press PAUSE.) ↑ ↑ ↑ RD -- 3-10 WB is set. WB is locked. WB high-speed setting mode WB outdoor mode WB indoor mode T he iris is opened forcibly. T he iris is closed forcibly. A value of AGC gain is maximized. A value of AGC gain is minimized. Outputs color bar from MACS. Outputs white 100% from MACS. Outputs white 50% from MACS. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4-5 Checking the Lens Resetting <Generals> (1) Setting the address according to the table below allows to check whether the lens resetting is ended or not. (2) If the DATA (in hexadecimal representation) is D0 or D4, the lens has been reset. * In case of 40 or 44, the zoom lens has not yet been reset. * In case of 80 or 84, the focus lens has not yet been reset. MONIT OR ST EP PROCEDURE 1 1) Make setting shown at right. CS Function 2 00 Microcomputer operation ADDR MODE 4663 RD DT -- RAM data indication 4-6 Functional Check of Control Keys and Switches <Generals> (1) The MODE and FR MI-COM terminals can be checked in the service mode. With this function, the key-related operations and the connections between the keys and the MI-COM terminals can be checked in the product state. (2) Perform the check in the RD mode. 4-6-1 MODE MI-COM Input Port ST EP NAME 1 V3T oM PC 25 Li3V Detect DESCRIPT ION CS Function ADDR DAT A BIT PC mode communication:PC mode start 1 01 000A 4 Detection of decrease in lithium 1 01 0007 3 battery voltage 64 PANEL Open SW LCD open detection 1 01 0002 6 65 PANEL B/T SW LCD reverse detection 1 01 0002 5 66 EJECT SW EJECT detection 1 01 0002 4 67 Cassette IN SW Cassette IN detection 1 01 0002 3 68 Photo SW Full pressing of Photo SW 1 01 0002 2 69 Half Photo SW Halfway pressing of Photo SW 1 01 0002 1 70 ST ART /ST OP T rigger SW 1 01 0002 0 71 DC J DET DC JACK detection 1 01 0002 7 75 PAE/GREEN SW PAE mode select SW 1 01 0001 3 76 VT R POWER SW VCR mode SW 1 01 0001 2 77 CAM POWER SW Camera mode SW 1 01 0001 1 78 T /C PW SW T ape/Card SW 1 01 0001 0 79 SDET S terminal detection 1 01 0000 7 3-11 REMARK ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 4-6-2 MODE MI-COM A/D Port ST EP 87 NAME Batt A/D DESCRIPT ION CS Function ADDR AD DAT A(00 ∼FF) 1 0007 Battery voltage value Battery voltage 02 Battery type 88 Batt Info A/D 1 02 0006 REMARK 00 ∼33 34 ∼65 66 ∼99 9A ∼CD CE ∼FF Batt BP -535 BP -522 BP -511 Not BP -508 /512 89 A/D V Charge voltage 1 02 0005 Not observable 90 A/D I Charge current 1 02 0004 Not observable 91 KEY AD0 KEY A/D0 1 02 0003 00 ∼2B:CARDMIX,2C∼66 :SELF 92 KEY AD1 KEY A/D1 1 02 0002 00 ∼2B:DE ON/OFF,2C∼66 :DE SEL 93 KEY AD2 KEY A/D2 1 02 0001 00 ∼2B:ST OP ,2C∼66 :FF 67 ∼A6 :PLAY/PAUSE 95 KEY AD3 KEY A/D3 1 02 0000 00 ∼2B:REW ,2C∼66 :MENU 67 ∼A6 :MENU execution 4-6-3 FR MI-COM Input Port ST EP 9 NAME EXT DET DESCRIPT ION CS Function ADDR DAT A BIT 0 01 0000 7 External microphone detection REMARK (Audio. C) 107 AV DET AV jack detect 0 01 0004 3 338 USB DET USB Detect 0 01 0009 5 268 REC PROOF T ape recording inhibited 0 01 000A 4 214 CARD PRO Card recording inhibited 0 01 000A 2 4-6-4 FR MI-COM A/D Port ST EP NAME DESCRIPT ION CS Function ADDR AD DAT A( 00 ~FF) 339 SHOE ID1 AA SHOE ID1 0 02 000E 48 CASE IN Cassette detection 0 02 000C Cassette inserted Cassette not inserted 216 CARD DET CARD detection 0 02 000A Card inserted Card not inserted 137 T EMD Lens thermometer output 0 02 0008 285 ZOOMKEY Zoom key output 0 02 0007 217 I ENC IRIS ENC output 0 02 340 Y GYRO YAW side GYRO output 0 02 0005 50 P GYRO PIT H side GYRO output 0 02 0004 138 DEW AD DEW detection 0 02 0003 218 MSW AD Mechanical position 0 02 0002 286 T APE END Ending detection 0 02 0001 341 T APE T OP Beginning detection 0 02 0000 3-12 0006 T ELE side Intermediate Small diaphragm WIDE side Open REMARK ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 5. Service Hints 5-1 Arrangement of Circuit Boards The printed circuit boards are arranged as shown below. OPERATION KEY EJECT P.C.B. CCD P.C.B. CVF P.C.B. DC P.C.B. JACK P.C.B. R-KEY P.C.B. MAIN P.C.B. CAC P.C.B. CARD P.C.B. D SW2 P.C.B. LCD P.C.B. Fig.3-12 3-13 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 5-2 Location of Main Elements MAIN P.C.B. IC103 RESET IC100 MODE MI-COM IC301 MOTOR DRIVE IC300 OPE AMP FU1801 FU3205 IC102 BACKUP FU3201 FU3202 FU3204 FU3203 IC2100 VIF2 IC2301 VIC3 IC3204 2.5V REGULATOR IC2000 VRP2 IC2300 FLASH IC1802 OPE/AMP IC1102 MACS IC1101 SDRAM IC803 4V REGULATOR IC2302 SDRAM IC801 AUDIO INTERFACE IC3201 DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL IC3203 4.7V REGULATOR IC3202 2.7V REGULATOR IC802 SP DRIVER Fig. 3-13 3-14 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS CAC P.C.B. IC1701 MOTOR DRIVE IC1002 TG/CDS/AGC/AD IC1001 V-DRIVER IC1502 EEPROM JACK P.C.B. IC1202 IRIS DRIVE IC1501 EVF DRIVER LCD P.C.B. IC1601 P SENSOR GYRO IC4201 DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL IC1602 Y SENSOR GYRO IC903 LCD DRIVE Fig. 3-14 3-15 IC902 SERI/PARA CONVERTER IC901 EEPROM ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 5-3 Current Consumption Check The following table shows the specified value of current consumption in each status. Measurement condition Preset voltage : Product status, camera auto mode(AF,IS OFF), LCD ON (Approx. 0.1A each smaller in case of CVF) : 7.4V POWER SW CAMERA VCR MODE Current consumption (A) REC PAUSE 0.46 REC 0.51 STOP 0.45 PLAY 0.54 POWER OFF 0.3 (mA) 3-16 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 6. Trouble Shooting To detect the failure part for repair, if any, use the following hints and check points. 6-1 Power Supply <Hints> When the power source is attached, the unit enters the standby mode in the following sequences. Main power is connected. → UNREG is supplied to the MAIN P.C.B. → MODE microcomputer starts up. → MODE microcomputer outputs VCR ON “H” signal. → PWM driver starts up and turns on each power supply. → Establishes communication with the FR microcomputer. → FR microcomputer initializes recorder mechanical chassis. → After initialized, the MODE MI-COM is brought into the standby status with the VCR ON changed to VCR Low. After that, the power supply is turned ON by the following procedures. Power supply mode switch operation → After MODE MI-COM is accepted, VCR ON “H” is output. → The PWM driver is started to turn on various power supplies. → The FR MI-COM is started to control the system. <Check Points> 1) Key Inputs 2) Check the key inputs at Power Switch in the SERVICE mode. Check of microcomputer-to-microcomputer communication If the microcomputer-to-microcomputer communication line is normal, the version number of each microcomputer can be indicated in the service mode. Otherwise, the communication line or microcomputer may be faulty. 3) Error in Mechanism (P. 3-8) If any error is occurred by mechanism trouble at initializing, the error can be detected. At this state, the power can be turned on, but the unit enters “ERROR STOP” state. In this case, check the error data in the SERVICE mode. 4) VCR ON “H”, CAM ON “H” (control signal from MODE microcomputer) Outputs Check the output of control signal by the LANC remote controller. 5) Fuses on the POWER SUPPLY P.C.B. Check the continuity of the fuses FU3201, 3202, 3203, 3204, 3205 and 1801 on the MAIN P.C.B. In case of NG, replace the fuse 6) and check the power consumption. Replace the MAIN P.C.B. with a service part and check the operation. 3-17 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 6-2 Camera Picture Faulty <Hints> A flow of camera picture (EE) is as below. CCD → CAC P.C.B. → MAIN P.C.B. (MACS → VIC3→VIF2) → JACK P.C.B. <Check Points> 1) Check of lens reset (p.3-11) If no camera picture appears, check if the lens has been reset by means of the service mode. In case of NG, check the lens. 2) Check of blue back output If the blue back is confirmed, the signal line subsequent to VIC3 is considered to be OK. 3) Check of MACS generation signal (white 100% or color bar) (P.3-10) The white 100% or color bar signals are generated by the MACS on the MAIN P.C.B. In the service mode, if the output of the white 4) 100% or color bar signal is attained, the signal line subsequent to MACS is considered to be OK. Check of CCD output 5) The CCD output is sampled by IC1002 (TG/CDS/AGC/AD). Check the signal. Check by command particular to camera (p.3-10) Check the operation of White balance, AGC, IRIS, etc. in the service mode. 3-18 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 6-3 Faulty of Playback Picture <Hints> In the DV, degradation of picture quality normally appears on the screen as block noise. This is because, if an error occurs exceeding the ability of the error correction circuit, the block by block information of pictures is not played back properly and thus complemented by the previous picture information. Normally, such block noise appears on the screen when the error rate has considerably been degraded due to the degraded tape or the lowered head output, etc. Be sure to check the playback picture quality by the error rate. <Check Points> 1) Deterioration of Tape Quality Check if flaws, kinks, etc. are found on a magnetic face of tape or not, and compare it with the error rate of other unit. 2) Error Rate (P. 3-7) In the service mode, check an error rate of self-recording/LP playback. The specified allowable error rate is 2 × 10-5. In case of NG, take the following procedure. (1) Observe a playback envelope. If it is abnormal, carry out tape-path adjustment. (2) Run a cleaning tape. Use the cleaning tape of hard type (DY9-1384-000). [Playback time] Hard cleaning tape (DY9-1384-000) : After replacement of the drum unit → 25 seconds For cleaning → 25 seconds per time, Up to three times * When using hard-type cleaning tape, select the cleaning mode on the product main unit. (Refer to 4-3 - Cleaning Mode, p. 3-10.) (3) Check the error rate again. If the error rate is out of the specified range, clean the tape drive parts (posts, drum) using cleaning paper moistened with alcohol. * Take care not to damage the head. * Do not touch the head with bare hand. (4) Check the error rate again. If the error rate is out of the specified range, replace the tape with a new one and check the error rate again. At this step, use a tape (must be Panasonic LP tape) which has been purchased at a different time. The error rate may become worse due to inconsistent quality or aging of the tape. (5) Check the error rate again. If the error rate is out of the specified range, replace the drum unit. (6) Check the error rate again. If the error rate is out of the specified range, replace the mechanical unit. 3-19 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 6-4 Startup Window Setting The startup window (user setting) contains a default image* at shipment from the factory. If any other image is written over the default image, it is deleted completely. So, be cautious in such cases as MAIN P.C.B. replacement. * Default image (Image file : Contained in “7. Appendix”.) User Setting 3-20 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS 7. Mechanical Error Applicability Table The address data in the mechanical error applicability table varies depending on the version of the FR MI-COM. Check the MI-COM version, and refer to the mechanical error applicability table relevant to the MI-COM version. Mechanical Error Applicability Table (for MAIN program version “C204” in FR MI-COM) Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW Loading error being stopped - - - - ● - ResetMechaGAP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - ● - ResetMechaSTOP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - - - 0A90E4 MechaLMOEmerg 0A9268 0A9398 0A9476 ResetMechaPLAY At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A95AA ResetMechaPOPUP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - ● - 0A9662 ResetMechaLD1 At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A97EE ResetMechaLD2 At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A9990 ResetMecha0020 At P. ON, changeover to mechanical reset end - - - - - - 0A9E70 MechaDoneToEjectEmerg Error EJECT - - - - ● - 0A9F5E MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0010 Error EJECT - ● - - ● - 0AA07A MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0020 Error EJECT - ● - - ● - 0AA146 MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0100 Error EJECT - - - - - - 0AA1C0 MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0200 Error EJECT - - - - ● - 0AA26A MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0210 Error EJECT - - - - - - 0AA500 MechaDoneToEject Error EJECT ● ● - - - - 0AA94A MechaStopToEject0020 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AAAC6 MechaStopToEject0030 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AACD6 MechaStopToEject0040 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AAE32 MechaStopToEject0050 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AAF06 MechaStopToEject0060 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AAF98 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0010 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - ● - - ● - 0AB05A MechaStopToEjectNoCas0020 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB11C MechaStopToEjectNoCas0030 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB1D4 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0040 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB29C MechaStopToEjectNoCas0050 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB71A MechaStopLoop Stop - - - - - ● 0AB7EA MechaEjectToStop Tape loading start ● ● - - - ● 0ABD36 MechaEjectToStop0020 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) - ● - - ● ● 0ABF0A MechaEjectToStop0030 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AC0B6 MechaEjectToStop0200 Tape being loaded (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AC17E MechaEjectToStop0210 Tape being loaded (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AC3E4 MechaEjectToStop0100 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) ● - - - - - 0AC472 MechaEjectToStop0110 Blank search start - - - - ● ● 0AC4CE MechaEjectToStop0111 Tape loading end (Tape inserted) - - - - - - 0AC516 MechaEjectToStop0120 Blank search start - ● - - - ● 0AC658 MechaEjectToStop0124 Blank search start - - - 8Dh - ● 0AC6E0 MechaEjectToStop0128 Blank search start - ● - - - ● 0AC83A MechaEjectToStop0130 Blank being searched - - 8Dh - - ● 0AC9AC MechaEjectToStop0132 Changeover to blank search end - - - - - - 0ACA16 MechaEjectToStop0133 Changeover to blank search end - ● 8Dh 8Dh - ● 0ACE8A MechaEjectToStop0136 Changeover to blank search end - ● - - - ● 0AD05E MechaEjectToStop0137 Changeover to blank search end - ● - 8Dh - ● 0AD102 MechaEjectToStop0138 Changeover to blank search end - - - 8Dh - ● 3-21 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0AD172 MechaEjectToStop0139 Changeover to blank search end - - - - - - 0AD218 MechaEjectToStop0140 Changeover to blank search end - ● - - - ● 0AD3C4 MechaEjectToStop0180 Changeover to blank search end - - - - ● - 0AD4C2 MechaFFToStop Changeover : FF → STOP - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AD6EE MechaRewToStop Changeover : REW → STOP - ● 8Dh - ● ● 0ADA2E MechaRecPauseToStop Changeover : Rec Pause → STOP - ● CEh - ● ● 0ADD9C MechaPlayToStop Changeover : PLAY → STOP - - - 8Dh ● ● 0ADEB0 MechaStillToStop Changeover : Still → STOP - ● CEh - ● ● 0AE274 MechaXToEnd Start of processing at end of tape - ● - - - ● 0AE5C6 MechaXToEnd0010 Processing at end of tape - - 8Dh - - ● 0AE64A MechaXToEnd0020 Processing at end of tape - ● 8Dh - - ● 0AEB0C MechaXToEnd0030 Processing at end of tape - - - - ● - 0AEC04 MechaTopLoop Processing at beginning of tape - - - - - ● 0AEC6C MechaXToTop Start of processing at beginning of tape - ● - - - - 0AEEA0 MechaXToTop0020 Processing at beginning of tape - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AF146 MechaFFLoop FF - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF1F4 MechaFFSlowToFF Changeover : FF × 9.5 → × 30 - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF2C6 MechaFFToFFSlow Changeover : FF × 30 → × 9.5 - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF372 MechaHSCueToFFSlow Changeover : CUE → FF - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF3FE MechaStopToFFSlow Changeover : STOP → FF ● ● - - ● ● 0AF62A MechaRewLoop REW - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF6D8 MechaRewSlowToRew Changeover : REW × 9.5 → × 30 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF7AA MechaRewToRewSlow Changeover : REW × 30 → × 9.5 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF856 MechaHSRevToRewSlow Changeover : REV → REW × 9.5 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF902 MechaStopToRewSlow Changeover : STOP → REW ● ● ● - ● ● 0AFC12 MechaRecLoop Rec - - - 8Dh - ● 0AFC8E MechaRecPauseToRec Rec start - - - - - - 0B000A MechaRecPauseToRec0010 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B0090 MechaRecPauseToRec0012 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B01B2 MechaRecPauseToRec0015 Changeover to Rec start - ● - - - ● 0B0338 MechaRecPauseToRec0020 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B052C MechaRecPauseLoop Rec PAUSE - - - - - - 0B058A MechaStopToRecPause Changeover : STOP → REC ● ● - - ● ● 0B0702 MechaStopToRecPause0010 Changeover : STOP → REC - - - - - - 0B0860 MechaESFStillToRecPause Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - - - - 0B08D2 MechaESRStillToRecPause Changeover to Rec search RVS end - ● CEh - - ● 0B0B2A RecEndingSequence Changeover to Rec end - - - - - - 0B0D08 RecEndingSequence0010 Changeover to Rec end - ● - - - ● 0B0FFE RecEndingSequence0030 Changeover to Rec end - ● - - - ● 0B115E RecEndingSequence0050 Changeover to Rec end - - - - - - 0B141E MechaPlayLoop PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B14B0 MechaStopToPlay Changeover : STOP → PLAY ● ● - - ● ● 0B15DC MechaStopTopToPlay Changeover : STOP → PLAY ● ● - - ● ● 0B1716 MechaStopTopToPlay0010 Changeover : STOP → PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B17F0 MechaStopTopToPlay0020 Changeover : STOP → PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B1880 MechaStillFwdToPlay Changeover : Still → PLAY - ● - - - ● 0B1B40 MechaFwd1xToPlay Capstan × 1 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 0B1D20 MechaFwd1xLoop Capstan × 1 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 3-22 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW - - 8Dh - ● - - 8Dh - ● ● - - - ● - - - ● - - - ● 0B1DBC MechaPlayToFwd1x PLAY - 0B1E1E MechaFwd2xToFwd1x Changeover : capstan × 2 → × 1 - 0B2022 MechaStillFwdToFwd1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - 0B22A8 MechaStillRvsToFwd1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● 0B24F0 MechaStillRvsToFwd1x0010 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - 0B25B0 MechaStillRvsToFwd1x0020 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B294E MechaRvs1xLoop Capstan × 1 being rotated - - 8Dh - - ● 0B29B4 MechaRvs2xToRvs1x Changeover : capstan × 2 → × 1 - - 8Dh - - ● 0B2A18 MechaStillRvsToRvs1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 0B2BDE MechaStillFwdToRvs1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 0B2E06 MechaStillFwdToRvs1x0010 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B2EC6 MechaStillFwdToRvs1x0020 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B30E4 MechaFwd2xLoop Capstan × 2 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 0B314A MechaFwd1xToFwd2x Changeover : capstan × 1 → × 2 rotation - - - 8Dh - ● 0B31DA MechaCueToFwd2x CUE end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B32FA MechaRvs2xLoop Capstan × 2 being rotated - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3360 MechaRvs1xToRvs2x Changeover : capstan × 1 → × 2 - - 8Dh - - ● 0B33C4 MechaRevToRvs2x Changeover to REV end - - 8Dh - - ● 0B34CE MechaCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3534 MechaFwd2xToCue Changeover to CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B35FE MechaHSCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3664 MechaFFToHSCue Changeover : FF → CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B38D0 MechaLCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3936 MechaFFToLCue Changeover : FF → CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3B5C MechaReviewLoop REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3BC2 MechaRvs2xToRev Changeover to REV start - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3C8E MechaHSReviewLoop REV - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3CF4 MechaRewToHSReview Changeover : REW → REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3F68 MechaLReviewLoop REV - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3FCE MechaRewToLReview Changeover : REW → REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B42DA MechaStillFwdLoop Still - - - - - - 0B431A MechaPlayToStillFwd Changeover : PLAY → Still - - - 8Dh - ● 0B448A MechaPlayToStillFwd0025 Changeover : PLAY → Still - - - - - - 0B44EC MechaStillRvsToStillFwd Changeover : Still RVS → Still FWD - - - - - - 0B45C8 MechaStillRvsToStillFwd0010 Changeover : Still RVS → Still FWD - - - - - - 0B4640 MechaFrameFwdToStillFwd Changeover : Forward fame feed → Still RVS - - - - - - 0B476C MechaStillRvsLoop Still - - - - - - 0B47AC MechaStillFwdToStillRvs Changeover : Still FWD → Still RVS - - - - - - 0B4888 MechaStillFwdToStillRvs0010 Changeover : Still FWD → Still RVS - - - - - - 0B48F4 MechaFrameRvsToStillRvs Changeover : Reverse frame feed → Still - - - - - - 0B4954 MechaSlowRvsToStillRvs Changeover : 1/10 slow RVS → Still - - - - - - 0B4A0E MechaStillFwdToFrameFwd Changeover to forward frame feed start - ● - - - ● 0B4A94 MechaFrameFwd0000 Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 0B4BA6 MechaStillRvsToFrameRvs Changeover to reverse frame feed start - ● - - - ● 0B4C2C MechaFrameRvs0000 Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0B4E1E MechaSlow10Fwd0000 1/10 slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0B51F4 MechaStillFwdToSlow10Fwd Changeover : Still → 1/10 slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0B5634 MechaSlow10Rvs0000 1/10 slow RVS - ● - - - ● 3-23 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW Changeover : Still → 1/10 slow RVS 0B5A0A MechaStillRvsToSlow10Rvs - 0B5E48 MechaShuttleFwdLoop Edit search FWD - 0B5EAE MechaStillFwdToShuttleFwd Changeover : Still → Edit search FWD - ● - ● 8Dh - ● - - ● - - - - ● - 0B6110 MechaShuttleRvsLoop Edit search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0B6176 MechaStillRvsToShuttleRvs Changeover : Still → Edit search RVS - ● - - - ● 0B6398 MechaSEFStillLoop Edit search FWD still - - - - - - 0B63D0 MechaShuttleFwdToSEFStill Edit search FWD → Edit search FWD still - - - 8Dh - ● 0B651C MechaShuttleFwdToSEFStill0025 Edit search FWD → Edit search FWD still - - - - - - 0B65E0 MechaSERStillLoop Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B6618 MechaShuttleRvsToSERStill Edit search RVS → Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B674A MechaShuttleRvsToSERStill0020 Edit search RVS → Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B67FE MechaEdPauseRvsLoop Changeover to Rec REW (RVS → FWD) - - - - - - 0B6836 MechaRecPauseToEdPauseRvs Rec search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B6C7C MechaRReviewRvsLoop Changeover to Rec REW - - - - - - 0B6CB4 MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs Rec REW (RVS) start - ● - - - - 0B6E2C MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs0012 Rec search RVS (RVS) - - CEh - - ● 0B6EF2 MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs0015 Changeover to Rec search RVS (RVS) end - ● 8Dh - - ● 0B7128 MechaRReviewFwdLoop Changeover to REC REW - - - - - - 0B7160 MechaRRRvsToRRFwd Changeover to REC REW - ● 8Dh - - ● 0B74C6 MechaRRRvsToRRFwd0031 Changeover to REC REW - - - 8Dh - ● 0B762A MechaRRRvsToRRFwd0035 Changeover to REC REW - - - 8Dh - ● 0B7AA2 MechaEdSearchFwdLoop Rec search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0B7B08 MechaRecPauseToEdSearchFwd Rec search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B7C4E MechaESFStillToEdSrchFwd Changeover : Rec search FWD → - ● - - - ● - ● - - - ● Rec search FWD 0B7D82 MechaESRStillToESF Changeover : Rec search RVS → Rec search FWD 0B82DA MechaEdSearchRvsLoop Rec search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0B8340 MechaEPRToEdSearchRvs Rec search RVS start - ● CEh - - ● 0B8436 MechaESFStillToESR Changeover : Rec search FWD → - ● - - - ● Rec search RVS 0B8792 MechaESFStillLoop Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - - - - 0B87CA MechaEdSearchFwdToESFStill Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B897A MechaESRStillLoop Changeover to Rec search RVS end - - - - - - 0B89B2 MechaESRToESRStill Changeover to Rec search RVS end - - - - - - 0B8DA6 MechaRStillToPhotoSearchFwd Photo search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B8FBE MechaPhotoSearchFwd0000 Photo search FWD start ● - - - ● - 0B907E MechaPhotoSearchFwd0030 Photo search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B9156 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0070 Photo search FWD start - - - 8Dh - ● 0B91AA MechaPhotoSearchFwd0090 Photo search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0B925A MechaPhotoSearchFwd0100 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B939A MechaPhotoSearchFwd0110 Changeover to photo search FWD end - ● - - - ● 0B9560 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0120 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B95CC MechaPhotoSearchFwd0130 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B9688 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0570 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B9746 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0580 Photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B98E0 MechaFStillToPhotoSearchRvs Changeover: Still → photo search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B9AF4 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0000 Photo search RVS start ● - - - ● - 3-24 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0B9BC0 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0030 Photo search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B9C34 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0040 Photo search RVS start - - - - - ● 0B9CD0 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0070 Photo search RVS start - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9D30 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0075 Photo search RVS start - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9D92 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0080 Photo search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9E40 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0100 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9FAA MechaPhotoSearchRvs0110 Changeover to photo search RVS end - ● - - - ● 0BA268 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0120 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA2D4 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0130 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA3B8 MechaPhotoSearchRvs1080 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA476 MechaPhotoSearchRvs1090 Photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA58C MechaDsearchFwd1000 Date search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0BA692 MechaDsearchFwd1010 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BA9BE MechaDsearchFwd1020 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● - 8Dh - ● 0BAC4A MechaDsearchFwd1030 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - - - ● 0BAD0A MechaDsearchFwd1040 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● CEh - - ● 0BAF18 MechaDsearchFwd1050 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● 8Dh - - ● 0BB0EE MechaDsearchFwd1065 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BB2A4 MechaDsearchFwd1080 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - ● - - - ● 0BB550 MechaDsearchFwd1090 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - - - - ● 0BB610 MechaDsearchFwd1100 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BB8B4 MechaDsearchFwd1200 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BB946 MechaDsearchFwd1210 Changeover to date search RVS end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BBB52 MechaDsearchRvs1000 Date search FWD - - 8Dh - - ● 0BBD2C MechaATNFwd0010 ATN search FWD start ● ● - CEh ● ● 0BBF80 MechaATNFwd0020 ATN search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC15C MechaATNFwd0035 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC1DA MechaATNFwd0040 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC2EA MechaATNFwd0050 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC3E8 MechaATNFwd0060 ATN search FWD end - - - - - - 0BC488 MechaATNRvs0010 ATN search RVS start ● ● CEh - ● ● 0BC756 MechaATNRvs0020 ATN search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0BC8FC MechaATNRvs0035 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BC970 MechaATNRvs0040 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BCA84 MechaATNRvs0050 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BCB34 MechaATNRvs0055 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - - - - ● 0BCBEE MechaATNRvs0060 ATN search RVS end - - - - - ● 0BCCE4 MechaAIPauseLoop Dubbing pause - - - - - - 0BCD1C MechaStillToAIPause Changeover: Still → Audio dubbing pause - ● CEh - - ● 0BD0A6 MechaStillToAIPause0010 Changeover: Still → Audio dubbing pause - - - - - - 0BD0FE MechaAInsertToAIPause Changeover to audio dubbing end - ● CEh - - ● 0BD516 MechaAInsertToAIPause0010 Dubbing end - - - - - ● 0BD602 MechaAInsertLoop Dubbing - - - 8Dh - ● 0BD676 MechaAIPauseToAInsert Dubbing start - ● - - - ● 0BD7C2 MechaAVINSLoop AV insert - - - 8Dh - ● 0BD7F0 MechaRecPauseToAVINS AV insert start - - - - - - 0BD8A6 MechaAVINSPauseToAVINS0010 Changeover to AV insert start - - - - - - 0BD914 MechaAVINSPauseToAVINS0020 AV insert start - ● - - - ● 3-25 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0BDA60 MechaRecPauseToAVIPause Changeover to AV insert pause - - - - - - 0BDAAE 0BDAE6 MechaAVIPauseLoop AV insert pause - - - - - - MechaAVInsertToAVIPause AV insert end - - - - - - 0BDF48 ABSFwdSlw Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BDFE8 ABSRvsSlw Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BE088 TurnRvsToFwd Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - ● - - - ● 0BE2F6 TurnRvsToFwd0010 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - ● 0BE3B8 TurnRvsToFwd0020 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - - 0BE522 TurnRvsToFwd0030 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - 8Dh - ● 0BE592 TurnRvsToFwd0040 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - - 0BE65E TurnRvsToFwd0060 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - ● - - - ● 0BE76A TurnFwdToRvs Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - ● - - - ● 0BE9D2 TurnFwdToRvs0010 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - ● 0BEA94 TurnFwdToRvs0020 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - - 0BEBFE TurnFwdToRvs0030 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0BEC6E TurnFwdToRvs0040 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - - 0BED3A TurnFwdToRvs0060 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - ● - - - ● 0BEE46 RepeatFrameFwd Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BEF28 RepeatFrameRvs Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BF73A MechaErrorStop Mechanical error recovery (error stop) - - - - ● - 0C1646 MechaStillFwdToNewFSlow5 Changeover: Still → Slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0C16C0 MechaNewFSlow5Loop Slow FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0C170E MechaNewFSlow5ToFStill Changeover: Slow FWD → Still - - - - - - 0C1758 MechaStillRvsToNewRSlow5 Changeover: Still → Slow RVS - ● - - - ● 0C17D4 MechaNewRSlow5Loop Slow RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0C1822 MechaNewRSlow5ToRStill Changeover: Slow RVS → Still - - - - - - 0C24E4 MechaRecReady Changeover to Rec pause - - - - - ● 0C25B0 MechaRecReady0010 Changeover to Rec pause - - - - - ● 3-26 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mechanical Error Applicability Table (for MAIN program version “1224” in FR MI-COM) Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0A9130 MechaLMOEmerg Loading error being stopped - - - - ● - 0A92B4 ResetMechaGAP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - ● - 0A93E4 ResetMechaSTOP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - - - 0A94C2 ResetMechaPLAY At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A95F6 ResetMechaPOPUP At P. ON, mechanical reset - - - - ● - 0A96AE ResetMechaLD1 At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A983A ResetMechaLD2 At P. ON, mechanical reset ● - - - ● - 0A99DC ResetMecha0020 At P. ON, changeover to mechanical reset end - - - - - - 0A9EBC MechaDoneToEjectEmerg Error EJECT - - - - ● - 0A9FAA MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0010 Error EJECT - ● - - ● - 0AA0C6 MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0020 Error EJECT - ● - - ● - 0AA192 MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0100 Error EJECT - - - - - - 0AA20C MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0200 Error EJECT - - - - ● - 0AA2B6 MechaStopEmergToEjectEmerg0210 Error EJECT - - - - - - 0AA54C MechaDoneToEject Error EJECT ● ● - - - - 0AA996 MechaStopToEject0020 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AAB12 MechaStopToEject0030 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AAD22 MechaStopToEject0040 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AAE7E MechaStopToEject0050 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AAF52 MechaStopToEject0060 EJECT (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AAFE4 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0010 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - ● - - ● - 0AB0A6 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0020 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB168 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0030 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB220 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0040 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB2E8 MechaStopToEjectNoCas0050 EJECT (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AB766 MechaStopLoop Stop - - - - - ● 0AB836 MechaEjectToStop Tape loading start ● ● - - - ● 0ABD82 MechaEjectToStop0020 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) - ● - - ● ● 0ABF56 MechaEjectToStop0030 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) - - - - ● ● 0AC102 MechaEjectToStop0200 Tape being loaded (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AC1CA MechaEjectToStop0210 Tape being loaded (Tape not inserted) - - - - ● - 0AC430 MechaEjectToStop0100 Tape being loaded (Tape inserted) ● - - - - - 0AC4BE MechaEjectToStop0110 Blank search start - - - - ● ● 0AC51A MechaEjectToStop0111 Tape loading end (Tape inserted) - - - - - - 0AC562 MechaEjectToStop0120 Blank search start - ● - - - ● 0AC6A4 MechaEjectToStop0124 Blank search start - - - 8Dh - ● 0AC72C MechaEjectToStop0128 Blank search start - ● - - - ● 0AC886 MechaEjectToStop0130 Blank being searched - - 8Dh - - ● 0AC9F8 MechaEjectToStop0132 Changeover to blank search end - - - - - - 0ACA62 MechaEjectToStop0133 Changeover to blank search end - ● 8Dh 8Dh - ● 0ACED6 MechaEjectToStop0136 Changeover to blank search end - ● - - - ● 0AD0AA MechaEjectToStop0137 Changeover to blank search end - ● - 8Dh - ● 0AD14E MechaEjectToStop0138 Changeover to blank search end - - - 8Dh - ● 0AD1BE MechaEjectToStop0139 Changeover to blank search end - - - - - - 0AD264 MechaEjectToStop0140 Changeover to blank search end - ● - - - ● 0AD410 MechaEjectToStop0180 Changeover to blank search end - - - - ● - 0AD50E MechaFFToStop Changeover : FF → STOP - - - 8Dh ● ● 3-27 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0AD73A MechaRewToStop Changeover : REW → STOP - ● 8Dh - ● ● 0ADA7A MechaRecPauseToStop Changeover : Rec Pause → STOP - ● CEh - ● ● 0ADDE8 MechaPlayToStop Changeover : PLAY → STOP - - - 8Dh ● ● 0ADEFC MechaStillToStop Changeover : Still → STOP - ● CEh - ● ● 0AE2C0 MechaXToEnd Start of processing at end of tape - ● - - - ● 0AE612 MechaXToEnd0010 Processing at end of tape - - 8Dh - - ● 0AE696 MechaXToEnd0020 Processing at end of tape - ● 8Dh - - ● 0AEB58 MechaXToEnd0030 Processing at end of tape - - - - ● - 0AEC50 MechaTopLoop Processing at beginning of tape - - - - - ● 0AECB8 MechaXToTop Start of processing at beginning of tape - ● - - - - 0AEEEC MechaXToTop0020 Processing at beginning of tape - - - 8Dh ● ● 0AF192 MechaFFLoop FF - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF240 MechaFFSlowToFF Changeover : FF × 9.5 → × 30 - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF312 MechaFFToFFSlow Changeover : FF × 30 → × 9.5 - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF3BE MechaHSCueToFFSlow Changeover : CUE → FF - - - 8Dh - ● 0AF44A MechaStopToFFSlow Changeover : STOP → FF ● ● - - ● ● 0AF676 MechaRewLoop REW - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF724 MechaRewSlowToRew Changeover : REW × 9.5 → × 30 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF7F6 MechaRewToRewSlow Changeover : REW × 30 → × 9.5 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF8A2 MechaHSRevToRewSlow Changeover : REV → REW × 9.5 - - 8Dh - - ● 0AF94E MechaStopToRewSlow Changeover : STOP → REW ● ● ● - ● ● 0AFC5E MechaRecLoop Rec - - - 8Dh - ● 0AFCDA MechaRecPauseToRec Rec start - - - - - - 0B0056 MechaRecPauseToRec0010 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B00DC MechaRecPauseToRec0012 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B01FE MechaRecPauseToRec0015 Changeover to Rec start - ● - - - ● 0B0384 MechaRecPauseToRec0020 Changeover to Rec start - - - - - - 0B0578 MechaRecPauseLoop Rec PAUSE - - - - - - 0B05D6 MechaStopToRecPause Changeover : STOP → REC ● ● - - ● ● 0B074E MechaStopToRecPause0010 Changeover : STOP → REC - - - - - - 0B08AC MechaESFStillToRecPause Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - - - - 0B091E MechaESRStillToRecPause Changeover to Rec search RVS end - ● CEh - - ● 0B0B76 RecEndingSequence Changeover to Rec end - - - - - - 0B0D54 RecEndingSequence0010 Changeover to Rec end - ● - - - ● 0B104A RecEndingSequence0030 Changeover to Rec end - ● - - - ● 0B11AA RecEndingSequence0050 Changeover to Rec end - - - - - - 0B146A MechaPlayLoop PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B14FC MechaStopToPlay Changeover : STOP → PLAY ● ● - - ● ● 0B1628 MechaStopTopToPlay Changeover : STOP → PLAY ● ● - - ● ● 0B1762 MechaStopTopToPlay0010 Changeover : STOP → PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B183C MechaStopTopToPlay0020 Changeover : STOP → PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B18CC MechaStillFwdToPlay Changeover : Still → PLAY - ● - - - ● 0B1B8C MechaFwd1xToPlay Capstan × 1 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 0B1D6C MechaFwd1xLoop Capstan × 1 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 0B1E08 MechaPlayToFwd1x PLAY - - - 8Dh - ● 0B1E6A MechaFwd2xToFwd1x Changeover : capstan × 2 → × 1 - - - 8Dh - ● 0B206E MechaStillFwdToFwd1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 0B22F4 MechaStillRvsToFwd1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 3-28 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0B253C MechaStillRvsToFwd1x0010 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B25FC MechaStillRvsToFwd1x0020 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B299A MechaRvs1xLoop Capstan × 1 being rotated - - 8Dh - - ● 0B2A00 MechaRvs2xToRvs1x Changeover : capstan × 2 → × 1 - - 8Dh - - ● 0B2A64 MechaStillRvsToRvs1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 0B2C2A MechaStillFwdToRvs1x Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - ● - - - ● 0B2E52 MechaStillFwdToRvs1x0010 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B2F12 MechaStillFwdToRvs1x0020 Changeover : Still → capstan × 1 - - - - - ● 0B3130 MechaFwd2xLoop Capstan × 2 being rotated - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3196 MechaFwd1xToFwd2x Changeover : capstan × 1 → × 2 rotation - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3226 MechaCueToFwd2x CUE end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3346 MechaRvs2xLoop Capstan × 2 being rotated - - 8Dh - - ● 0B33AC MechaRvs1xToRvs2x Changeover : capstan × 1 → × 2 - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3410 MechaRevToRvs2x Changeover to REV end - - 8Dh - - ● 0B351A MechaCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3580 MechaFwd2xToCue Changeover to CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B364A MechaHSCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B36B0 MechaFFToHSCue Changeover : FF → CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B391C MechaLCueLoop CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3982 MechaFFToLCue Changeover : FF → CUE - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3BA8 MechaReviewLoop REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3C0E MechaRvs2xToRev Changeover to REV start - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3CDA MechaHSReviewLoop REV - - - 8Dh - ● 0B3D40 MechaRewToHSReview Changeover : REW → REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B3FB4 MechaLReviewLoop REV - - - 8Dh - ● 0B401A MechaRewToLReview Changeover : REW → REV - - 8Dh - - ● 0B4326 MechaStillFwdLoop Still - - - - - - 0B4366 MechaPlayToStillFwd Changeover : PLAY → Still - - - 8Dh - ● 0B44D6 MechaPlayToStillFwd0025 Changeover : PLAY → Still - - - - - - 0B4538 MechaStillRvsToStillFwd Changeover : Still RVS → Still FWD - - - - - - 0B4614 MechaStillRvsToStillFwd0010 Changeover : Still RVS → Still FWD - - - - - - 0B468C MechaFrameFwdToStillFwd Changeover : Forward fame feed → Still RVS - - - - - - 0B47B8 MechaStillRvsLoop Still - - - - - - 0B47F8 MechaStillFwdToStillRvs Changeover : Still FWD ® Still RVS - - - - - - 0B48D4 MechaStillFwdToStillRvs0010 Changeover : Still FWD ® Still RVS - - - - - - 0B4940 MechaFrameRvsToStillRvs Changeover : Reverse frame feed ® Still - - - - - - 0B49A0 MechaSlowRvsToStillRvs Changeover : 1/10 slow RVS ® Still - - - - - - 0B4A5A MechaStillFwdToFrameFwd Changeover to forward frame feed start - ● - - - ● 0B4AE0 MechaFrameFwd0000 Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 0B4BF2 MechaStillRvsToFrameRvs Changeover to reverse frame feed start - ● - - - ● 0B4C78 MechaFrameRvs0000 Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0B4E6A MechaSlow10Fwd0000 1/10 slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0B5240 MechaStillFwdToSlow10Fwd Changeover : Still → 1/10 slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0B5680 MechaSlow10Rvs0000 1/10 slow RVS - ● - - - ● 0B5A56 MechaStillRvsToSlow10Rvs Changeover : Still → 1/10 slow RVS - ● - - - ● 0B5E94 MechaShuttleFwdLoop Edit search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0B5EFA MechaStillFwdToShuttleFwd Changeover : Still → Edit search FWD - ● - - - ● 0B615C MechaShuttleRvsLoop Edit search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 3-29 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0B61C2 MechaStillRvsToShuttleRvs Changeover : Still → Edit search RVS - ● - - - ● 0B63E4 MechaSEFStillLoop Edit search FWD still - - - - - - 0B641C MechaShuttleFwdToSEFStill Edit search FWD → Edit search FWD still - - - 8Dh - ● 0B6568 MechaShuttleFwdToSEFStill0025 Edit search FWD → Edit search FWD still - - - - - - 0B662C MechaSERStillLoop Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B6664 MechaShuttleRvsToSERStill Edit search RVS → Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B6796 MechaShuttleRvsToSERStill0020 Edit search RVS → Edit search RVS still - - - - - - 0B684A MechaEdPauseRvsLoop Changeover to Rec REW (RVS → FWD) - - - - - - 0B6882 MechaRecPauseToEdPauseRvs Rec search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B6CC8 MechaRReviewRvsLoop Changeover to Rec REW - - - - - - 0B6D00 MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs Rec REW (RVS) start - ● - - - - 0B6E78 MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs0012 Rec search RVS (RVS) - - CEh - - ● 0B6F3E MechaEdPauseRvsToRRRvs0015 Changeover to Rec search RVS (RVS) end - ● 8Dh - - ● 0B7174 MechaRReviewFwdLoop Changeover to REC REW - - - - - - 0B71AC MechaRRRvsToRRFwd Changeover to REC REW - ● 8Dh - - ● 0B7512 MechaRRRvsToRRFwd0031 Changeover to REC REW - - - 8Dh - ● 0B7676 MechaRRRvsToRRFwd0035 Changeover to REC REW - - - 8Dh - ● 0B7AEE MechaEdSearchFwdLoop Rec search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0B7B54 MechaRecPauseToEdSearchFwd Rec search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B7C9A MechaESFStillToEdSrchFwd Changeover : Rec search FWD → - ● - - - ● - ● - - - ● Rec search FWD 0B7DCE MechaESRStillToESF Changeover : Rec search RVS → Rec search FWD 0B8326 MechaEdSearchRvsLoop Rec search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0B838C MechaEPRToEdSearchRvs Rec search RVS start - ● CEh - - ● 0B8482 MechaESFStillToESR Changeover : Rec search FWD → - ● - - - ● Rec search RVS 0B87DE MechaESFStillLoop Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - - - - 0B8816 MechaEdSearchFwdToESFStill Changeover to Rec search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B89C6 MechaESRStillLoop Changeover to Rec search RVS end - - - - - - 0B89FE MechaESRToESRStill Changeover to Rec search RVS end - - - - - - 0B8DF2 MechaRStillToPhotoSearchFwd Photo search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B900A MechaPhotoSearchFwd0000 Photo search FWD start ● - - - ● - 0B90CA MechaPhotoSearchFwd0030 Photo search FWD start - ● - - - ● 0B91A2 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0070 Photo search FWD start - - - 8Dh - ● 0B91F6 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0090 Photo search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0B92A6 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0100 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0B93E6 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0110 Changeover to photo search FWD end - ● - - - ● 0B95AC MechaPhotoSearchFwd0120 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B9618 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0130 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B96D4 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0570 Changeover to photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B9792 MechaPhotoSearchFwd0580 Photo search FWD end - - - - - - 0B992C MechaFStillToPhotoSearchRvs Changeover: Still → photo search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B9B40 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0000 Photo search RVS start ● - - - ● - 0B9C0C MechaPhotoSearchRvs0030 Photo search RVS start - ● - - - ● 0B9C80 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0040 Photo search RVS start - - - - - ● 0B9D1C MechaPhotoSearchRvs0070 Photo search RVS start - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9D7C MechaPhotoSearchRvs0075 Photo search RVS start - - 8Dh - - ● 3-30 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0B9DDE MechaPhotoSearchRvs0080 Photo search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9E8C MechaPhotoSearchRvs0100 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0B9FF6 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0110 Changeover to photo search RVS end - ● - - - ● 0BA2B4 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0120 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA320 MechaPhotoSearchRvs0130 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA404 MechaPhotoSearchRvs1080 Changeover to photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA4C2 MechaPhotoSearchRvs1090 Photo search RVS end - - - - - - 0BA5D8 MechaDsearchFwd1000 Date search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0BA6DE MechaDsearchFwd1010 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BAA0A MechaDsearchFwd1020 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● - 8Dh - ● 0BAC96 MechaDsearchFwd1030 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - - - ● 0BAD56 MechaDsearchFwd1040 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● CEh - - ● 0BAF64 MechaDsearchFwd1050 Changeover to date search FWD end - ● 8Dh - - ● 0BB13A MechaDsearchFwd1065 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BB2F0 MechaDsearchFwd1080 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - ● - - - ● 0BB59C MechaDsearchFwd1090 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - - - - ● 0BB65C MechaDsearchFwd1100 Changeover to date search FWD/RVS end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BB900 MechaDsearchFwd1200 Changeover to date search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BB992 MechaDsearchFwd1210 Changeover to date search RVS end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BBB9E MechaDsearchRvs1000 Date search FWD - - 8Dh - - ● 0BBD78 MechaATNFwd0010 ATN search FWD start ● ● - CEh ● ● 0BBFCC MechaATNFwd0020 ATN search FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC1A8 MechaATNFwd0035 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC226 MechaATNFwd0040 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC336 MechaATNFwd0050 Changeover to ATN search FWD end - - - 8Dh - ● 0BC434 MechaATNFwd0060 ATN search FWD end - - - - - - 0BC4D4 MechaATNRvs0010 ATN search RVS start ● ● CEh - ● ● 0BC7A2 MechaATNRvs0020 ATN search RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0BC948 MechaATNRvs0035 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BC9BC MechaATNRvs0040 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BCAD0 MechaATNRvs0050 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - 8Dh - - ● 0BCB80 MechaATNRvs0055 Changeover to ATN search RVS end - - - - - ● 0BCC3A MechaATNRvs0060 ATN search RVS end - - - - - ● 0BCD30 MechaAIPauseLoop Dubbing pause - - - - - - 0BCD68 MechaStillToAIPause Changeover: Still → Audio dubbing pause - ● CEh - - ● 0BD0F2 MechaStillToAIPause0010 Changeover: Still → Audio dubbing pause - - - - - - 0BD14A MechaAInsertToAIPause Changeover to audio dubbing end - ● CEh - - ● 0BD562 MechaAInsertToAIPause0010 Dubbing end - - - - - ● 0BD64E MechaAInsertLoop Dubbing - - - 8Dh - ● 0BD6C2 MechaAIPauseToAInsert Dubbing start - ● - - - ● 0BD80E MechaAVINSLoop AV insert - - - 8Dh - ● 0BD83C MechaRecPauseToAVINS AV insert start - - - - - - 0BD8F2 MechaAVINSPauseToAVINS0010 Changeover to AV insert start - - - - - - 0BD960 MechaAVINSPauseToAVINS0020 AV insert start - ● - - - ● 0BDAAC MechaRecPauseToAVIPause Changeover to AV insert pause - - - - - - 0BDAFA MechaAVIPauseLoop AV insert pause - - - - - - 0BDB32 MechaAVInsertToAVIPause AV insert end - - - - - - 0BDF94 ABSFwdSlw Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 3-31 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 3. INFORMATION FOR REPAIR · SERVICE HINTS Mecha Error Address Label Sequence Drum Caps SReel TReel Loading DEW 0BE034 ABSRvsSlw Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BE0D4 TurnRvsToFwd Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - ● - - - ● 0BE342 TurnRvsToFwd0010 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - ● 0BE404 TurnRvsToFwd0020 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - - 0BE56E TurnRvsToFwd0030 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - 8Dh - ● 0BE5DE TurnRvsToFwd0040 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - - - - - - 0BE6AA TurnRvsToFwd0060 Changeover: Still RVS → Still FWS - ● - - - ● 0BE7B6 TurnFwdToRvs Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - ● - - - ● 0BEA1E TurnFwdToRvs0010 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - ● 0BEAE0 TurnFwdToRvs0020 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - - 0BEC4A TurnFwdToRvs0030 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0BECBA TurnFwdToRvs0040 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - - - - - - 0BED86 TurnFwdToRvs0060 Changeover: Still FWS → Still RVS - ● - - - ● 0BEE92 RepeatFrameFwd Forward frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BEF74 RepeatFrameRvs Reverse frame feed - ● - - - ● 0BF786 MechaErrorStop Mechanical error recovery (error stop) - - - - ● - 0C16D4 MechaStillFwdToNewFSlow5 Changeover: Still → Slow FWD - ● - - - ● 0C174E MechaNewFSlow5Loop Slow FWD - - - 8Dh - ● 0C179C MechaNewFSlow5ToFStill Changeover: Slow FWD → Still - - - - - - 0C17E6 MechaStillRvsToNewRSlow5 Changeover: Still → Slow RVS - ● - - - ● 0C1862 MechaNewRSlow5Loop Slow RVS - - 8Dh - - ● 0C18B0 MechaNewRSlow5ToRStill Changeover: Slow RVS → Still - - - - - - 0C2572 MechaRecReady Changeover to Rec pause - - - - - ● 0C263E MechaRecReady0010 Changeover to Rec pause - - - - - ● 3-32 CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT CONTENTS 1. Disassembling and Reassembling ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-1 1-1 Disassembling / Reassembling Flowchart ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-1 1-2 Separation of Front Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-2 1-3 Separation of Accessory Shoe ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-3 1-4 Separation of Right Cover Unit ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-4 1-5 Separation of Rear Cover Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-5 1-6 Separation of Jack P.C.B ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-6 1-7 Separation of Left Cover Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-7 1-8 Separation of Camera Unit ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-8 1-9 Separation of Main and CAC P.C.B.'s ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-9 1-10 Separation of Recorder Holder --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-10 1-11 Separation of Front Cover Unit --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-11 1-12 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 1 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-12 1-13 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 2 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-13 1-14 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 3 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-14 1-15 Separation of LCD Unit ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-15 1-16 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 1 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-16 1-17 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 2 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-17 1-18 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 3 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-18 1-19 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 4 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-19 1-20 Disassembling of LCD Unit - 1 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-20 1-21 Disassembling of LCD Unit - 2 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-21 1-22 Separation of CVF Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-22 1-23 Separation of Rear Cover Unit ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-23 1-24 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 1 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-24 1-25 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 2 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-25 1-26 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 3 --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-26 1-27 Disassembling of Camera Unit - 1 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-27 1-28 Disassembling of Camera Unit - 2 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-28 1-29 Disassembling of Lens Unit ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-29 1-30 List of Screws Used ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-30 1-31 List of Disassembly Photos -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-31 2. Adjustment Procedures ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-33 2-1 Adjustment Items in Part Replacement -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-33 2-2 AF Section Adjustment -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-34 2-2-1 CZ Automatic Adjustment ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-34 2-2-2 Cam Correction (AUTO) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-35 2-3 IS Section Adjustment --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-36 2-3-1 GYRO OFFSET Adjustment -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-36 2-3-2 GYRO GAIN Adjustment ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-36 2-3-3 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing ------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-37 2-4 Camera Section Adjustment -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-38 2-4-1 Iris Adjustment ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-38 2-4-2 WB Adjustment (1) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-38 2-4-3 Color Balance Adjustment ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-39 2-4-4 WB Adjustment (2) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-39 2-4-5 WB Adjustment (3) ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-40 2-4-6 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing ------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-40 2-5 CCD Pixel Missing Compensation ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-41 2-6 Color Balance Check ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-42 2-7 Recorder Section Adjustment ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-43 2-7-1 Setting for Destination ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-43 2-7-2 Y LEVEL Adjustment ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-44 2-7-3 C LEVEL Adjustment ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-45 2-7-4 AGC Initial Value Adjustment ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-45 2-7-5 SWP Adjustment ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-46 2-7-6 C. FG Adjustment --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-46 2-7-7 Automatic Adjustment of Reel FG -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-46 2-7-8 Flash Memory Writing --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-46 2-7-9 Battery Voltage Drop Adjustment --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-47 2-8 Tape Path Adjustment ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-48 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1. Disassembling and Reassembling Notes : (1) When replacing the flat cable with a new one, allow it to remain folded the same as the original part. (2) The flat cable has a contact orientation to be engaged with the connector. Refer to the instructions in the disassembly procedure diagram and interconnection diagram for boards. ⋅ Lateral engaging connector (The instructions are given in the disassembly procedure diagram and board interconnection diagram.) : Contacts are positioned downward. (board side) ∗ : Contacts are positioned upward. ⋅ Lengthwise engaging connector (The instructions are given only in the boards interconnection diagram.) Indicated by →. Arrowheads indicate the contacts, and the shafts indicate the noncontacts. (3) To secure screws, apply the Three Bond 1401B (CY9-8011-000) (4) If any part to be replaced has UL tape attached on it, be sure to reattach UL tape at the same position in reassembling. 1-1 Disassembling / Reassembling Flowchart (1) Find the replacement part on the chart, and disassemble it following the instruction on chart. (2) Reassembling can be made by reversing the disassembling procedures. : MAIN FLOW START : SUB FLOW 1-2 Front Cover Unit 1-11 Mic Ass'y : MAIN UNIT 1-3 Accessory Shoe 1-4 Right Cover Unit 1-15 LCD Unit 1-20 Hinge Ass'y 1-16 CARD P.C.B. 1-21 LCD P.C.B. 1-17 R-KEY Back Light Ass'y 1-18 R-KEY P.C.B. 1-18 DSW2 P.C.B. 1-5 Rear Cover Unit 1-22 CVF Unit 1-6 JACK P.C.B. 1-23 DC P.C.B. 1-7 Left Cover Unit 1-12 Operetion Key Ass'y 1-8 Recorder, Camera Unit 1-26 CVF P.C.B. 1-13 Speaker Ass'y 1-9 CAC P.C.B. 1-13 EJECT P.C.B. 1-9 MAIN P.C.B. 1-14 Cassette Arm Ass'y 1-10 Recorder Holder 1-8 Recorder Unit 1-10 DMC III 1-8 Camera Unit 1-28 CCD P.C.B. 1-29 Lens Unit 4-1 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-2 Separation of Front Unit (1) Open the cassette cover, F Jack Cover and L Jack Cover and remove seven screws (b × 5, c × 1, d × 1). (2) Disconnect CN701 and detach the Front Cover Unit. (3) Remove the Cushion. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Attach the Cushion at the position shown in the figure. Run the MIC cable through the slit of the Cushion. Cassette Cover Front Cover Unit (1) - b Cushion (1) - b L Jack Cover (1) (1) (3) (1) - b (2) CN701 (2) Note on Reassembling (1) (1) Hold the cushion by IR-LED holder. (1) - d Take care to prevent the cushion from being pushed out of this line to the right side. (1) - b (1) - c F Jack Cover Cushion b c 3mm Metal M1.7 d 4mm Metal M1.7 Run the MIC Cable through the slit of the Cushion. 4.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) CN701 Fig. 4-1 4-2 Take care to prevent the cushion from hanging over the boss. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-3 Separation of Accessory Shoe (1) Remove four screws (a × 4) and detach the Accessory Shoe. (1) - a Accessory Shoe (1) a 5mm Metal M1.7 Flat Head Screw Fig. 4-2 4-3 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-4 Separation of Right Cover Unit (1) Remove five screws (b × 3, c × 1, d × 1), disconnect CN990, CN1502 and CN4001 and detach the Right Cover Unit. (2) Draw out the Shaft and detach the Card Cover. (Only for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) <Note on Reassembling> (1) Push the CN990 and CN1502 sufficiently so as to prevent them from being pinched in the part A. (2) Since the Shaft may come out easily, take care not to lose the Shaft. (Only for ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A) Before using the Card Cover and Shaft supplied for repair service, remove their protection sheet and shaft-dropping preventive tape. (1) - b (1) - d (1) - b CN990 (1) (1) (1) (1) CN4001 CN1502 (2) Note on Reassembling (1) (1) - b Right Cover Unit (1) - c ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A only Card Cover Shaft back of the Right Cover Unit A b c 3mm Metal M1.7 d 4mm Metal M1.7 Shaft remove 4.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) Fig. 4-3 4-4 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-5 Separation of Rear Cover Unit (1) Remove three screws (d × 3), disconnect the CN1501, CN3201 and CN3202 and detach Rear Cover Unit. CN1501 (1) (1) CN3202 (1) (1) CN3201 d (1) - d Rear Cover Unit Fig. 4-4 4-5 4.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-6 Separation of Jack P.C.B (1) Remove two screws (b × 2), disconnect the CN5, CN2101 and CN6 and detach the Jack P.C.B. (2) Open the Cassette Cover and remove one screw (c × 1). Pull the part A to this side while lifting it, disengage the two claw parts B and detach the C Lock Plate Unit. (3) Remove two screws (b × 2) and detach the Tripod Base, C Lock Plate and Support Plate. <Note on Reassembling> (1) When reassembling the C Lock Plate Unit, insert the part C into the hole and reverse the disassembling procedures (2). Make sure that the two Dowels are connected. (1) - b Support Plate (2) CN5 (1) (1) CN2101 (1) C Lock Plate CN6 (2) - c (1) - b (3) JACK P.C.B. Tripod Base (2) (3) - b Dowels B Pull this part frontward. Lift it. b Part A Part C c 3mm Metal M1.7 C Lock Plate Unit Fig. 4-5 4-6 4mm Metal M1.7 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-7 Separation of Left Cover Unit (1) Remove three screws (b × 3), disconnect the CN101 and detach the Left Cover Unit. Left Cover Unit (1) - b (1) (1) CN101 (1) - b b 3mm Metal M1.7 Fig. 4-6 4-7 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-8 Separation of Camera Unit (1) Remove two screws (b × 2), disconnect the CN891, CN1001 and CN1201 and detach the Camera Unit. Note : The CN891 connector should be disconnected in the ZR70 MC A only. In the ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A, it is not required to disconnect the CN891 connector since the shoe connector Ass’y and its relevant flexible cable are not provided. Camera Unit (1) - b (1) - b (1) (1) (1) CN1001 (1) b 3mm Metal M1.7 CN1201 CN891 (ZR70 MC A only) Fig. 4-7 4-8 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-9 Separation of Main and CAC P.C.B.'s (1) Remove one screw (b × 1), disconnect the CN1101 and CN1002 (B to B) and detach the CAC P.C.B. (2) Remove three screws (b × 3), disconnect the CN300, CN301, CN302, CN303, and CN2000 and detach the MAIN P.C.B. (3) Detach the soldered part on the PM Shield 1 and detach the HA Shield and PM Shield 1 and 2. DMC III HA Shield (2) MAIN P.C.B. CN301 Solder (2) - b (2) PM Shield 1 CN2000 (3) CN300 CN303 (3) (2) - b PM Shield 2 (1) CN302 CN1101 (B to B) b CN1002 (B to B) (2) - b (1) - b 3mm Metal M1.7 CAC P.C.B. Fig. 4-8 4-9 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-10 Separation of Recorder Holder (1) Remove three screws (e × 3) and detach the Recorder Holder, vibration isolating Rubber and Spring. Note : When placing the DMC III mechanical unit with the recorder holder removed, be sure to orient the drum side upward. Take care not to touch the tape running surface of the drum. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Before mounting the Recorder Holder, make sure that three vibration isolating Rubber parts have been attached properly. (2) When using the vibration isolating Rubber parts supplied for repair service, apply HANAL KS-39M (DY9-3053-000) to the entire surface of each vibration isolating Rubber part. (3) Attach the Spring as illustrated below. (4) Attach UL Tape as illustrated below to secure the Flexible Cable. DMC III Recorder Holder (1) Rubber Spring (1) - e Rubber e 3.4mm Metal M1.4 CAUTION Be sure to place the unit with its drum facing upward. Rubber (1) - e Note on Reassembling (3) Spring Fig. 4-9 4-10 Note on Reassembling (4) UL Tape (9 × 15) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-11 Separation of Front Cover Unit (1) Remove three screws (d × 3) and detach the Lens Cover, L Jack Cover and F Jack Cover. (2) Remove two screws (d × 2) and detach the Microphone Cover, Rubber, Microphone Ass'y and Microphone Shield. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Treat the Microphone Ass'y Cable as illustrated below. Front Cover Unit (2) - d (1) - d L Jack Cover (1) Black/ Red Black/ Rubber White MIC Holder (1) MIC Ass'y (2) MIC Shield (1) Lens Cover Note on Reassembling (1) F Jack Cover d Black/Red 4.5mm Black/White Take care to make the four cables come out of the front cover in line so as to prevent them from crossing each other. Metal M1.7 (self tap) Fig. 4-10 4-11 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-12 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 1 (1) Remove four screws (d × 4) and detach the Operation Key Ass'y. (2) Remove the Shaft and detach the Hand Strap. (3) Remove one screw (d × 1) and detach the Change Plate and Change Knob. (Only for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) <Note on Reassembling> (1) Attach the Change Knob, Change Plate and Operation Key Ass'y Change SW as illustrated below. (Only for ZR70 MC A, ZR65MC A) <Instruction for Supplies> Change Plate part on Left Cover : HANAL FL-778 (DY9-3026-000) (Only for ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A) ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A only Change Knob Change Plate Hand Strap Operation Key Ass'y (3) - d (1) (1) - d (2) Shaft d 4.5mm (1) - d Metal M1.7 (self tap) Instruction for Supplies (ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A only) (1) - d Note on Reassembling (1) (ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A only) Change Knob Change SW Change Plate Hanal FL-778 Fig. 4-11 4-12 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-13 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 2 (1) Remove two screws (f × 2) and detach the GND Plate, Cushion, Speaker Holder and Speaker Ass'y. (2) Remove one screw (i × 1) and detach the EJECT P.C.B. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Run the Speaker Ass’y cable under the GND Plate and secure it with the Cushion as illustrated below. Extend the cable to the underside of the line on the Left Cover. Speaker Ass'y (1) Speaker Holder EJECT P.C.B. (2) (1) - f (1) Cushion (2) - i (1) - f GND Plate Note on Reassembling (1) Extend the cable to the underside of the line. White Black i f 2.5mm 4mm Black M1.7 (self tap) Metal M1.7 GND Plate Speaker Align the cushion with the end of rib and the end of plate. Fig. 4-12 4-13 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-14 Disassembling of Left Cover Unit - 3 (1) Remove four screws (i × 4) and detach the Cassette Cover while taking care of the two claw parts. (2) Remove three screws (f × 3) and detach the Cassette Arm Ass'y. (3) Detach the Open Knob. Cassette Cover Claw (1) - i Left Cover Cassette Arm Ass'y (3) (2) - f (1) - i Claw (1) (1) - i Open Knob (2) - f (2) f 4mm Black M1.7 (self tap) i 2.5mm Metal M1.7 (2) - f Fig. 4-13 4-14 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-15 Separation of LCD Unit (1) Disconnect the CN101. (2) Open and turn the LCD Unit, remove four screws (c × 2, d × 2) and detach the LCD Unit. <Note on Reassembling> (1) For the DSW Cable, provide wiring arrangement as shown below. CN101 (1) (2) Note on Reassembling (1) CN101 (2) - c LCD Unit (2) DSW Cable Hook the cable over the both ends of the DSW2 P.C.B. c d 4mm Metal M1.7 (2) - d 4.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) Fig. 4-14 4-15 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-16 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 1 (1) Detach the Lithium Battery Cover. (2) Remove four screws (h × 4), disconnect the CN4002 and detach the Card P.C.B. and AP Knob. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Bend the Flexible cable and secure it with UL Tape as illustrated below. Hook the right edge of the CARD P.C.B. to the Claw part A for mounting. (2) In remounting, engage the SW4004 knob on the CARD P.C.B. with the AP Knob. Note on Reassembling (1) Claw A CARD P.C.B. Lithium Battery Cover (1) Claw A (2) CN4002 AP Knob (2) (2) - h (2) h SW4004 4mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) CARD P.C.B. Fig. 4-15 4-16 (2) - h ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-17 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 2 (1) Remove the Cushion. (2) Remove two screws (g × 1, h × 1), disconnect the CN100 and detach the R-Key Backlight Ass'y and R-Key Backlight Holder. (Only for ZR70 MC A) Note : List the R-Key Backlight Ass’y while pressing the part A of R-Key Backlight Holder outward, and slide the ass’y to detach it while taking care not to damage the Flexible Cable. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Attach the Cushion at the position as illustrated below. CN100 ZR70 MC A only R-KEY Back Light Holder (2) (2) R-KEY Back Light Ass'y (2) - h (2) (1) Note on Reassembling (1) Cushion ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A (2) - g Cushion Shorter cushion for ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A (Same affixing position) g Metal M1.7 Caution DSW2 P.C.B. h 2mm R-KEY Back Light Ass'y Part A Align the cushion with the step difference surface. Align the cushion with the rib surface. FPC Fig. 4-16 4-17 4mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-18 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 3 (1) Remove nine screws (d × 3, g × 4, j × 2) and the two soldered parts A and detach the R-Key P.C.B., DSW2 P.C.B., Holders 1 and 2, GND Plates 1 and 2 and Card Cover Lock. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Treat the DSW2 P.C.B. cable as illustrated below. Hook the top of the DSW2 P.C.B. to the Claw part B for mounting. (2) Treat the R-Key P.C.B. flexible cable as illustrated below. When using the part supplied for repair service, bend the flexible cable part A to 45°. (3) Attach UL Tape at the position indicated in the figure shown below. (Only for ZR70 MC A) Note on Reassembling (3) (ZR70 MC A only) UL Tape (5 × 10) Attach UL Tape according to the profile of the Connector. (1) UL Tape (5 × 10) (1) - g R-KEY P.C.B. Claw B Soldered Parts A (1) - g (1) - d Holder 1 (1) Holder 2 (1) (1) - g (1) - d DSW2 P.C.B. (1) - d GND Plate 1 (1) - j Card Cover Lock Note on Reassembling (2) Flexible Cable Plate 1 part A Note on Reassembling (1) ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A only DSW2 P.C.B. Claw B GND Plate 2 (1) - j d g 4.5mm Take care to prevent the cable from hanging over the boss part. Metal M1.7 (self tap) j 2mm Metal M1.7 Fig. 4-17 4-18 5.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) Hold the flexible cable part A with the plate. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-19 Disassembling of Right Cover Unit - 4 (1) Remove one screw (j × 1) and detach the LCD Lock Holder, LCD Lock, LCD Open Knob, LCD Lifter, and Spring 1and 2. <Note on Reassembling> (1) With both ends of spring 2 engaged with the Hook, assemble the LCD Lock into the Right Cover Unit. Then, after mounting the LCD Lock Holder, remove the part A from the Hook. Note : (1) If the part-A side is not removed from the Hook, the specified level of spring pressure is not provided at the LCD Lock. (2) If the part is not unhooked after reassembling the LCD lock holder, the LCD lock could be detached from the right cover unit. LCD Open Knob (1) (1) LCD Lock Holder (1) (1) - j LCD Lifter Spring 1 (1) Note on Reassembling (1) LCD Lock Spring 2 Part A j 5.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) Spring 2 Fig. 4-18 4-19 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-20 Disassembling of LCD Unit - 1 (1) Remove three screws (b × 3) and detach the LCD Top Cover. Note : When detaching the LCD Top Cover, be careful of the claw parts A and B inside the cover. (2) Disconnect the CN901 and CN902 and detach the Hinge Ass'y. <Note on Reassembling> (1) When attaching the Hinge Ass'y, take care not to pinch the white cable of Backlight Ass'y. (2) Before attaching the LCD Top Cover, be sure to insert the claw part A. (3) Insert the CN901 and CN902 to their deepest positions securely, and check if there is no gap due to insufficient seating. CN901 (2) (2) (1) - b (2) CN902 Hinge Ass'y (1) - b (1) Note on Reassembling (1) LCD Top Cover CN901 Check that there is no gap due to unseating. CN902 (1) - b Claw B Claw A b 3mm Inside the LCD top cover Metal M1.7 Fig. 4-19 4-20 Hinge Ass'y Take care not to pinch the cable. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-21 Disassembling of LCD Unit - 2 (1) Detach the LCD Bottom Cover and Bottom Cover Sheet. (2) Detach the soldered parts A and B, disconnect the CN903, remove one screw (b × 1) and detach the LCD P.C.B. (3) Demount the LCD Ass'y from the Backlight Ass'y. Note : The LCD Unit can be disassembled without detaching the Right Cover Unit. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Detach the Bottom Cover Sheet by sliding it between the LCD Bottom Cover and the LCD Holder. Take care to prevent the Bottom Cover Sheet from hanging out of the LCD Bottom Cover. (2) Treat the Backlight Ass'y Cable as illustrated below. After performing soldering, secure the Cable with adhesive. <Instruction for Supplies> Securing of Backlight Ass'y Cable : DIA BOND 1663G Note on Reassembling (1) LCD Bottom Cover Bottom Cover Sheet Bottom Cover Sheet (1) LCD P.C.B. Back Light Ass'y (1) Soldered Parts A Soldered Parts B LCD Holder (3) LCD Ass'y Note on Reassembling (2) Instruction for Supplies CN903 (2) (2) Diabond (2) - b b 3mm Metal M1.7 Fig. 4-20 4-21 Soldered Parts B Diabond Soldered Parts A ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-22 Separation of CVF Unit (1) Remove UL Tape. (2) Remove six screws (o × 4, p × 2) and detach the CVF Unit. Note : (1) When drawing out the CVF-CAC FPC on the CVF Unit from the Rear Cover Unit, take care not to damage the CVF-CAC. (2) On approx. 5,000 units in the initial lot (ZR70 MC A : 1,000 units, ZR65 MC A : 2,000 units, ZR60 A : 2,000 units), four screws (o × 2, p × 2) are used for mounting the CVF unit instead of six screws (o × 4, p × 2), i.e., two screws (o × 2) are not used. To increase retaining strength on these units, an adhesive agent has been applied to the four screws (o × 2, p × 2) before shipment from the factory. When removing these screws, take care not to damage the threads of them. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Attach the CVF-CAC FPC as illustrated below. Secure it with UL Tape. (2) On approx. 5,000 units in the initial unit only (ZR70 MC A : 1,000 units, ZR65 MC A : 2,000 units, ZR60 A : 2,000 units) : When attaching each of the screws, tighten it securely until it does not turn further without applying a new adhesive. CVF Unit (2) (2) - p Rear Cover Unit o (2) - o p 3mm Metal M1.7 (Noji Rock) 4mm Metal M1.7 (Noji Rock) Note on Reassembling (1) (2) - p Bend the CVF-CAC FPC. (2) - o (1) Insert the CVF-CAC FPC into the grooves. UL Tape Fig. 4-21 4-22 UL Tape (20 × 10) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-23 Separation of Rear Cover Unit (1) Remove four screws (h × 4) and detach the Battery Terminal Ass'y and GND Plate. (2) Remove one screw (h × 1) and detach the DC P.C.B. (3) Detach the Battery Eject Lever and Sring. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Secure the cables of Battery Terminal Ass'y with the hooks as illustrated below. (2) When attaching the Battery Terminal Ass'y, screw the Red, Black, White and Gray cables in this order. <Instruction for Supplies> Rear Cover, Spring : Apply HANAL FL-778. (DY9-3026-000) Note on Reassembling (1) Red Black Secure the cables with the hooks. White Gray Secure the cables with the hooks. Rear Cover Spring (3) Battery Eject Lever Red GND Plate Black White (1) - h Gray (1) (2) (1) - h Instruction for Supplies Hanal FL-778 Battery Terminal Ass'y h 4mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) (2) - h DC P.C.B. Fig. 4-22 4-23 Hanal FL-778 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-24 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 1 (1) Detach the Dust Cover, remove two screws (b × 2) and detach the CVF Bottom Cover. (2) Remove one screw (d × 1), disengage the holes on CVF-CAC FPC from the protruded parts A and draw out the finder while taking care not to damage the CVF-CAC FPC. (3) Remove two screws (b × 2) and detach the CVF Hinge Ass'y. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Engage the holes on CVF-CAC FPC and the protruded parts A as illustrated below. (1) - b (2) - d CVF Bottom Cover (2) (1) Protruded Parts A CVF-CAC FPC CVF Hinge Ass'y Finder (3) - b (1) (3) Dust Cover CVF Top Cover Note on Reassembling (1) Protruded Parts A Hinge Ass'y (2) Lift Up Finder b d 3mm Remove Metal M1.7 4.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) Fig. 4-23 4-24 CVF-CAC FPC ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-25 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 2 (1) Remove two screws (d × 2) and detach the Eyepiece, CVF Lens Holder, CVF Knob, Rubber and Lens Holder. (2) Detach the two claw parts A and detach the Lens. <Note on Reassembling> (1) When attaching the Lens into the Lens Holder, take care to orient the lens correctly. (2) When attaching the CVF Knob, attach the Lens Holder Boss as illustrated below. Be sure to attach the rubber part. <Instruction for Supplies> Lens Holder contacting surface : HANAL KS-39M (DY9-3053-000) Rubber Top surface : HANAL KS-39M (DY9-3053-000) (1) - d (1) - d Eyepiece CVF Lens Holder Rubber CVF Knob (1) (1) (1) (2) d Lens 4.5mm (1) Metal M1.7 (self tap) Lens Holder Claw A Note on Reassembling (1) CVF Inner Cover CVF Inner Cover Lens Holder Lens Note on Reassembling (2) Rubber Instruction for Supplies Hanal KS-39M Lens Knob Boss Lens Holder Hanal KS-39M Rubber top surface Lens Holder contacting surface Fig. 4-24 4-25 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-26 Disassembling of CVF Unit - 3 (1) Disconnect the CN4101 and detach the CVF-CAC FPC. (2) Detach the three claw parts A and detach the components from the CVF P.C.B. to the Mask Plate. (3) Detach the two claw parts B, disconnect the CN4102 and separate the CVF P.C.B., reflector and LCD Ass'y. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Treat the LCD Ass'y flexible cable by inserting it into the CVF Inner Cover as illustrated below. (2) Before using the CVF-CAC FPC supplied for repair service, securely fold it at the position illustrated below. CVF Inner Cover Mask Plate CVF-CAC FPC Cushion Diffuser Reflector Claw A (1) LCD Ass'y CVF P.C.B. (2) Claw B CN4101 (3) CN4102 Note on Reassembling (1) Note on Reassembling (2) Folding in a crest form Folding in a trough form CVF-CAC FPC DH2-5022-000 TO CN4101 mk OR 1 03 Fig. 4-25 4-26 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-27 Disassembling of Camera Unit - 1 (1) Remove one screw (k × 1) and detach the Accessory Shoe. Note : Lift the hooked parts of the two Dowels diagonally and detach the Shoe Base backward. (2) Remove three screws (l × 3) and detach the Lens Holder, vibration isolating Rubber and Shield. <Note on Reassembling> (1) When using the vibration isolating Rubber parts supplied for repair service, apply HANAL FL-778 (DY9-3026-000) to the entire surface of each vibration isolating Rubber part. (2) Attach Shield at the position indicated in the figure shown below. Shoe Connector Ass'y (ZR70 MC A) Caution Shoe Spacer (ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A) Dowel Lift Up (1) - k Shoe Base Dowel Rubber Note on Reassembling (2) (1) Shield AAS FPC (ZR70 MC A only) Attach the shield so that the cutout of the shield is aligned with the hole on the Lens Holder lens holder. (Protrusion to the hole is not allowed.) (2) Lens Holder Rubber Shield Rubber (2) - l k l 3.8mm (2) - l Fig. 4-26 4-27 4.5mm Metal Black M1.7 M1.7 Steped Screw Steped Screw ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-28 Disassembling of Camera Unit - 2 (1) Remove two screws (m × 2) and detach the CCD P.C.B., CCD Ass'y, Rubber part and Low-Pass Filter. (2) Detach the soldered part A and detach the CCD P.C.B. and CCD Ass'y. <Note on Reassembling> (1) Before attaching the CCD P.C.B., secure the P.C.B. with screws (m × 2) and perform soldering of the CCD Ass'y and CCD P.C.B. Low-Pass Filter Rubber CCD Ass'y CCD P.C.B. (1) (2) m 6mm (1) - m Metal M1.7 (self tap) (2) Lens Face thick side toward Lens side A CCD Low-Pass Filter CCD P.C.B. Fig. 4-27 4-28 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-29 Disassembling of Lens Unit (1) Remove the Lens Rubber part and three screws (m × 3). Demount the Front Lens Ass'y. (2) Remove six screws (d × 4, n × 2) and solder (α). Demount the PZ Motor, AF Motor, IG Meter Ass'y, PZ Shaft, and AF Shaft. <Instruction for Supply> On the AF/PZ Shaft and Guide Bar : LOGENEST LAMBDA A-74 (CY9-8102-000) Instruction for Supply (2) - n (2) - d PZ Shaft AF Shaft AF Motor (2) LOGENEST LAMBDA A-74 Guide Bar × 2 (2) - α AF Shaft (2) - d Gide Bar IG Meter Ass'y (2) (2) - α Front Lens Ass'y PZ Motor (1) - m PZ Shaft (2) - α (1) Gide Bar m d 4.5mm (1) - m Metal M1.7 (self tap) (1) - m Lens Rubber Fig. 4-28 4-29 n 6mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) 3.5mm Metal M1.7 (self tap) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT PARTS NO. a XA1-3170-507 b XA1-7170-307 c XA1-7170-407 d XA4-9170-457 e XA9-1167-000 f XA4-9170-409 g XA1-7170-207 h XA4-9170-407 SYMBOL SYMBOL 1-30 List of Screws Used PARTS NO. 5mm i XA1-7170-257 M1.7-3.0mm (Metal) 3mm j XA4-9170-557 M1.7-4.0mm (Metal) 4mm k XA9-1349-000 4.5mm l XA9-1294-000 REMARKS Flat Head Screw M1.7-5.0mm (Metal) Self Tap M1.7-4.5mm (Metal) Stepped Screw M1.4-3.4mm (Metal) ILLUST 3.4mm m XA4-9170-607 Self Tap M1.7-4.0mm (Black) 4mm n XA4-9170-357 M1.7-2.0mm (Metal) 2mm o XA9-1481-000 4mm p XA9-1482-000 Self Tap M1.7-4.0mm (Metal) 4-30 REMARKS M1.7-2.5mm (Metal) Self Tap M1.7-5.5mm (Metal) Stepped Screw M1.7-3.8mm (Metal) ILLUST 2.5mm 5.5mm 3.8mm Stepped Screw M1.7-4.5mm (Black) 4.5mm Self Tap M1.7-6.0mm (Metal) 6mm Self Tap M1.7-3.5mm (Metal) Noji Rock Screw M1.7-3.0mm (Metal) Noji Rock Screw M1.7-4.0mm (Metal) 3.5mm 3mm 4mm ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 1-31 List of Disassembly Photos Front Side Right Side Recorder/Camera Unit Camera Unit-1 Camera Unit-2 Front Cover Unit 4-31 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT Left Cover Unit Right Cover Unit Rear Cover Unit 4-32 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2. Adjustment Procedures 2-1 Adjustment Items in Part Replacement After replacement of major parts, carry out adjustment referring to the table shown below. Note that the following table shows minimum required adjustments to be performed after replacing any major part. In case that two or more parts have been replaced or any faulty condition has occurred, take a proper adjustment procedure accordingly. ○ : Adjustment required Camera system Part name No. Adjustment item Lens JACK PCB CCD MAIN PCB CAC PCB Adjustment setting 2-2 AF section 2-2-1 CZ Automatic Adjustment ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-2-2 Cam correction (AUT O) ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-3 IS section 2-3-1 Gyro Offset Adjustment ○ ○ 2-3-2 Gyro Gain Adjustment ○ ○ 2-3-3 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing ○ ○ ○ Product condition ○ Product condition Product condition 2-4 Camera section 2-4-1 Iris Adjustment ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-4-2 WB Adjustment (1) ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-4-3 Color Balance Adjustment ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-4-4 WB Adjustment (2) ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-4-5 WB Adjustment (3) ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-4-6 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing ○ ○ ○ ○ Product condition 2-5 CCD Pixel Missing Compensation ○ ○ 2-6 Color Balance Check ○ ○ Product condition ○ Product condition Recorder system Part name No. Adjustment item MAIN PCB CAC PCB DMC III Adjustment setting 2-7 Recorder section 2-7-1 Setting for Destination Product condition ○ 2-7-2, 2-7-3 Y LEVEL / C LEVEL Adjustment ○ Product condition 2-7-4 AGC Initial Value Adjustment ○ Product condition 2-7-5 SWP Adjustment ○ ○ Product condition 2-7-6 C. FG Adjustment ○ ○ Product condition 2-7-7 Automatiac Adjustment of Reel FG ○ ○ 2-7-8 Flash Memory Writing ○ ○ 2-7-9 Battery Voltage Drop Adjustment ○ ○ Product condition DMC III 2-8 T ape Path Adjustment T ape path adjustment setting 4-33 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-2 AF Section Adjustment Note) (1) The sections 2-2-1 : CZ automatic adjustment and 2-2-2 : Cam correction (AUTO) must be executed consecutively. If they are performed independently, the sufficient performance cannot be obtained. Also, when section 2-2-1 : CZ automatic adjustment is completed, execute section 2-2-2 : Cam correction (AUTO) must be executed immediately without elapse of time. If execute section 2-2-2 : Cam correction (AUTO) is executed after elapse of time upon completion of section 2-2-1 : CZ automatic adjustment, the sufficient performance cannot be obtained. (2) The result data (*) of automatic adjustment is indicated in blinking because of the design of the MI-COM system. Preparation) (1) For CZ automatic adjustment/cam correction, set the product condition. (2) Adjustment condition (initial condition) Tape/Card : Tape Program AE ZOOM : Auto Mode : Telephoto-end CZ adjustment chart : 2.4 ± 0.02 m from lens front Chart luminance : 500 lux or more (High illuminance should be avoided at the wide-angle end.) 2-2-1 CZ Automatic Adjustment CHART CZ adjustment chart SPEC. At STEP 3, DT : AA should be attained. Execution of STEP 4. Procedure) (1) In the telephoto-end setting, bring the center of chart image to the center of monitor TV. (2) Referring to the table shown below, carry out CZ automatic adjustment in the service mode. (3) Perform the cam correction. ST EP PROCEDURE CZ 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 2 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 00 ST 465F 90 RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 3 4 Judgment on result of adjustment 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 2 08 ST 3100 ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 2 08 RD 3100 ↑ ↑ RD ↑ 0 08 0081 ↑ ↑ ST RD 4-34 ↑ Microcomputer operation Move to adjustment mode. 00 Automatic adjustment is started. T hen, it is completed in 30 seconds approximately. If any NG condition is encountered in automatic adjustment, check the parts inside the lens section. *AA Adjustment is completed (result is OK). Perform the cam correction. *FF Adjustment is completed (result is NG). T ake the procedure again from the beginning. 00 Preparation for flash memory updating. ↑ Execution of flash memory updating. ↑ ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-2-2 Cam Correction (AUTO) CHART CZ adjustment chart SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) Quit the service mode, and turn power OFF/ON. (2) Perform the cam correction by following the table below. (3) Quit the service mode, turn power off/on, and then check that proper focusing can be attained in normal zooming operation (AF OFF). (4) If the result is NG, perform 2-2-1 : CZ automatic adjustment and 2-2-2 : Cam correction (AUTO). MONIT OR ST EP PROCEDURE Microcomputer operation CAM CORRECT ION CS Function MD ADDR DT 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2 08 ST 3101 00 2) Perform storing. RD *01 ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) Cancel the service mode, and set the zoom position to the telephoto end. After focus movement is stopped, 2 turn OFF the AF function. 3 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2 08 ST 3202 00 WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 2) Perform storing. RD *02 Correction value measurement. ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) Completion with DT :02. 4 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2 08 ST 3104 00 2) Perform storing. RD *04 Correction value calculation. ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) Completion with DT :04. 5 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2 08 ST 3105 00 2) Perform storing. RD *AA Completion of correction value writing. ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) Completion with DT :AA. 6 1) Make the setting shown at right. 0 08 ST 0081 00 Preparation for flash memory updating. 2) Perform storing. RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Execution of flash memory updating. (press the PAUSE button.) 4-35 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-3 IS Section Adjustment Note) (1) Perform the IS adjustment after machine is re-assembled to a product status. (2) Prepare a tripod or stable work bench. (3) Each of the adjustment data (2-3-1 and 2) becomes valid when 2-3-3 data writing is made. After completion of each adjustment, be sure to carry out 2-3-3 before turning power OFF. (4) The result data (*) of automatic adjustment is indicated in blinking because of the design of the MI-COM system. 2-3-1 GYRO OFFSET Adjustment SPEC. Automatic adjusutment Procedure) (1) Wait at least 10 seconds while being careful not to apply vibration to the camera. (2) Referring to the table shown below, perform the automatic adjustment. Note) It will take approx. 25 seconds at maximum to complete adjustment (OK) after storing (pressing the pause button). ST EP PROCEDURE GYRO OFFSET 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 320D 00 RD *02 ↑ ↑ ↑ Microcomputer operation Adjustment is completed. Completion with DT :02, NG with DT :03 2-3-2 GYRO GAIN Adjustment SPEC. Data Writing Procedure) (1) Reset the data to be the original, referring to the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE GYRO GAIN 1 Gyro YAW gain adjustment 1-1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 2 Gyro PIT CH gain adjustment 2-1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ↑ ↑ 2 08 ↑ ↑ ST RD 3200 91 ↑ ↑ ST RD 3201 75 ↑ ↑ 4-36 Microcomputer operation Adjustment is completed. Adjustment is completed. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-3-3 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing SPEC. Automatic writing Procedure) (1) According to the table shown below, write adjustment data (2-3-1 and 2) into the virtual EEPROM and flash memory. ST EP PROCEDURE EEPROM & FLASH WRIT ING 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 2 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 320F 00 RD *02 ↑ ↑ ↑ 0 08 ↑ ↑ ST RD 0081 00 ↑ ↑ 4-37 Microcomputer operation Completion of virtual EEPROM writing. Completion with DT :02, NG with DT :03 Preparation for flash memory updating. Execution of flash memory updating. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-4 Camera Section Adjustment Notes) (1) Each adjustment data (2-4-1 to 2-4-5) becomes effective after it is written into the DATA as mentioned in 2-4-6. If power must be turned OFF/ON during each adjustment, be sure to perform the DATA write procedure as mentioned in 2-4-6. (2) The adjustments from 2-4-2 through 2-4-5 must be carried out in series. (3) The result data (*) of automatic adjustment is indicated in blinking because of the design of the MI-COM system. Preparation) (1) For camera section adjustment, take the product condition. (2) Adjustment condition (initial condition) Tape/Card Program AE : Tape : Auto Mode AF Image stabilizer : OFF : OFF Chart : Standard angle of view (Set the angle after setting the high address.) 2-4-1 Iris Adjustment CHART Light box (5600°K) SPEC. Automatic adjustment. Procedure) (1) Referring to the table shown below, adjust the Iris. ST EP PROCEDURE IRIS 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR Microcomputer operation CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 3000 00 WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Adjustment is in progress. RD * ↑ Adjustment is completed. ↑ ↑ ↑ Completion with DT :00 (In addition, NG) 2-4-2 WB Adjustment (1) CHART Light box (5600°K) SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) Referring to the table shown below, carry out WB adjustment (1). ST EP PROCEDURE WB (1) 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 3002 00 WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD *05 ↑ ↑ ↑ Microcomputer operation Adjustment is in progress. Adjustment is completed. Completion with DT :05 (In addition, NG) Note) In this adjustment, color balance gain data is set to FF. Be sure to carry out color balance adjustment described in 2-4-3. 4-38 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-4-3 Color Balance Adjustment CHART Lightbox (5600°K), and color bar chart (white area at the left side) M.EQ. Vectorscope TP/TRIG. VIDEO OUT SPEC. FR 1st microcomputer only R : × 1.7 (ratio to burst) 90°, Ye : × 1.0 (ratio to burst) 195° FR 2nd microcomputer and subsequent R : × 2.0 (ratio to burst) 90°, Ye : × 1.0 (ratio to burst) 180° * For the FR 1st computer, the camera program version indication (CA) is “C200”. * For the FR 2nd computer and subsequent, the camera program version indication (CA) is “1220”. Procedure) (1) For manual adjustment of color balance, change data at the following four addresses while observing a vectorscope. ST EP PROCEDURE CB (MANUAL) R-Y GAIN 1) In the setting shown at right, adjust relevant data. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) B-Y GAIN 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) R-Y MAT 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) B-Y MAT 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) CS 2 ↑ Microcomputer operation MONIT OR Function MD ADDR DT 08 ST 3007 "ADJ" Adjustment is in progress. RD ADJ Adjustment is completed. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ST RD 3008 "ADJ" Adjustment is in progress. ADJ Adjustment is completed. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ST RD 3009 "ADJ" Adjustment is in progress. ADJ Adjustment is completed. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ST RD 300A "ADJ" Adjustment is in progress. ADJ Adjustment is completed. ↑ 2-4-4 WB Adjustment (2) CHART Light box (5600°K), and CCA12 filter SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) Referring to the table shown below, carry out WB adjustment (2). ST EP PROCEDURE WB (2) 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 3004 00 WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD *05 ↑ ↑ ↑ 4-39 Microcomputer operation Adjustment is in progress. Adjustment is completed. Completion with DT :05 (In addition, NG) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-4-5 WB Adjustment (3) CHART Light box (5600°K) SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) Referring to the table shown below, carry out WB adjustment (3). ST EP PROCEDURE WB (3) 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR Microcomputer operation CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 3005 00 WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Adjustment is in progress. RD * ↑ Adjustment is completed. ↑ ↑ ↑ Completion with DT :00 (In addition, NG) 2-4-6 Virtual EEPROM and Flash Memory Writing SPEC. Automatic writing Procedure) (1) According to the table shown below, write adjustment data (2-4-1 to 2-4-5) into the virtual EEPROM and flash memory. ST EP PROCEDURE EEPROM & FLASH WRIT ING 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 2 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ST 3006 00 RD *02 ↑ ↑ ↑ 0 08 ↑ ↑ ST RD 0081 00 ↑ ↑ 4-40 Microcomputer operation Completion of virtual EEPROM writing. Completion with DT :02, NG with DT :03 Preparation for flash memory updating. Execution of flash memory updating. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-5 CCD Pixel Missing Compensation Notes) (1) Perform this adjustment only if a void pixel is found on the CCD. (2) Before starting this adjustment, turn power on for 30 minutes. (3) In this adjustment, NG is indicated if there are two or more pixel defects at the center of the screen or if there are eight or more pixel defects on the entire screen. (4) The result data (*) of automatic adjustment is indicated in blinking because of the design of the MI-COM system. Preparation) (1) Carry out this correction in the product state. (2) Adjustment Conditions Program AE : AUTO AF Image stabilizer : OFF : OFF Demo mode : OFF Procedure) (1) Perform the CCD void pixel correction (automatic mode) according to the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE 1 1-1 2 2-1 3 CCD void pixel correction 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) Virtual EEPROM writing 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 2 08 ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 2 08 ↑ ↑ 0 08 ↑ ↑ ST 300D WR ↑ RD ↑ ↑ *-- ST RD 300E ↑ 00 *02 ST RD 0081 00 ↑ ↑ 4-41 Microcomputer operation 00 Adjustment is in progress. Adjustment is completed. Completion with DT :00 to 0C, NG with DT :8* Completion of virtual EEPROM writing. Completion with DT :02, NG with DT :03 Preparation for flash memory updating. Execution of flash memory updating. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-6 Color Balance Check Preparation) (1) Carry out this correction in the product state. (2) Adjustment Conditions Program AE : AUTO AF Image stabilizer : OFF : OFF Demo mode : OFF CHART Lightbox (5600°K), and color bar chart M.EQ. Vectorscope TP/TRIG. VIDEO OUT SPEC. R : × 2.2 102° (± 0.15 ±5°), Ye : × 1.2 167° (± 0.15 ±5°), G : 260° (±5°) Procedure) (1) Quit the service mode, and turn power OFF/ON. (2) Perform light-box recording, and carry out WB SET using the relevant function of the product. (3) Take an image of the color bar chart, and check that the levels of R, Ye and G are within the specified ranges respectively. (4) If the result of the above check is NG, carry out camera section adjustment again. 4-42 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-7 Recorder Section Adjustment Note) (1) Each of the adjustment data (2-7-2 to 2-7-7) becomes valid when 2-7-8 flash memory writing is made. When turning power ON/ OFF during each adjustment, be sure to carry out 2-7-8 flash memory writing. Preparation) (1) Except for the tape-path adjustment, carry out adjustment in the product state. 2-7-1 Setting for Destination SPEC. Automatic writing Procedure) (1) Referring to the table shown below, carry out the setting for destination market place. ST EP PROCEDURE 1 2 3 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 1 10 ST 0064 F1 RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 1 10 ST 0069 ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ ↑ 1 10 ST 0071 ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ 4-43 00 01 02 ↑ 00 01 ↑ Microcomputer operation ZR70 MC A / ZR65 MC A / ZR60 A Data writing ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A Data writing ZR70 MC A / ZR65 MC A ZR60 A Data writing ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-7-2 Y LEVEL Adjustment TP/TRIG. VIDEO OUT M. EQ. Oscilloscope SPEC. 980 ± 20 [mV] Procedure) (1) Select the card VTR mode. (2) Referring to the table shown below, carry out Y level adjustment. Repeat steps 2) to 4) so that the level range shown at the right will be attained. * If the tape mode is selected, a delay may occur in re980 ± 20mV sponse. Fig. 4-29 ST EP PROCEDURE Y LEVEL 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Change data properly. 3) Perform storing. Microcomputer operation MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 10 ST 000D ADJ White raster is output. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ "ADJ" RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Adjustment data reflected (press the PAUSE button.) 4) Make the setting shown at right. ↑ ↑ ST ↑ ↑ Check level. 5) Perform storing. ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ Adjustment is completed. (press the PAUSE button.) 4-44 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-7-3 C LEVEL Adjustment TP/TRIG. VIDEO OUT M. EQ. Oscilloscope SPEC. 710 ± 20 [mV] Procedure) (1) Select the card VTR mode. (2) Referring to the table shown below, carry out C level adjustment. Repeat steps 2) to 4) so that the level range shown at the right will be attained. * If the tape mode is selected, a delay may occur in re- 710 ± 20mV sponse. Fig.4-30 ST EP PROCEDURE C LEVEL 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) For adjustment, change data properly. 3) Perform storing. Microcomputer operation MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 10 ST 000E ADJ Green raster is output. ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ "ADJ" RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Adjustment data reflected (press the PAUSE button.) 4) Make the setting shown at right. ↑ ↑ ST ↑ ↑ Check level. 5) Perform storing. ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ Adjustment is completed. (press the PAUSE button.) 2-7-4 AGC Initial Value Adjustment SIGNAL COLOR BAR MODE E-E (ANALOG LINE IN) SPEC. Automatic writing Procedure) (1) Input a color bar signal to the analog line circuit from the pattern generator. (2) Carry out AGC initial value adjustment according to the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE AGC INIT IAL 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 08 ST 0004 -WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 4-45 Microcomputer operation Automatic adjustment is in progress. Automatic adjustment is completed. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-7-5 SWP Adjustment MODE Playback of color bar master (DY9-1380-000) SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) While playing back the color bar master, carry out SWP automatic adjustment referring to the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE SWP (AUT O) 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 08 ST 0001 -WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Microcomputer operation Automatic adjustment is in progress. Automatic adjustment is completed. 2-7-6 C. FG Adjustment MODE Playback of color bar master (DY9-1380-000) SPEC. Automatic adjustment Procedure) (1) While playing back the color bar master, carry out C.FG automatic adjustment referring to the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE C.FG(AUT O) 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 08 ST 0003 -WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Microcomputer operation Automatic adjustment is in progress. Automatic adjustment is completed. 2-7-7 Automatic Adjustment of Reel FG MODE Stop without VTR cassette Procedure) (1) Carry out reel FG adjustment according to the following table. ST EP PROCEDURE 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 08 ST 0007 -WR ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ Microcomputer operation Automatic adjustment is in progress. Automatic adjustment is completed. 2-7-8 Flash Memory Writing SPEC. Memory data writing Procedure) (1) Write adjustment data (2-7-1 to 7) into the flash memory according the table shown below. ST EP PROCEDURE 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 0 08 ST 0081 00 RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 4-46 Microcomputer operation Preparation for flash memory updating. Execution of flash memory updating. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-7-9 Battery Voltage Drop Adjustment MODE During camera recording in product condition (AF : OFF, LCD PANEL : ON) SPEC. Power supply voltage: 5.85 ± 0.02 [V] Note) (1) Perform the adjustment after 4sec of recording start. Procedure) (1) Under the above condition, set a power supply voltage to 5.85 ± 0.02[V]. (2) Referring to the table shown below, carry out battery voltage drop adjustment. ST EP PROCEDURE BAT T ERY VOLT AGE DROP 1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 2) Perform storing. (press the PAUSE button.) MONIT OR CS Function MD ADDR DT 1 08 ST -RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ 4-47 Microcomputer operation Adjustment is completed. ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT 2-8 Tape Path Adjustment Note) (1) For tape path adjustment, the service mode setting is necessary. For the details of setting procedure, refer to the DMC III Section. Preparation) (1) For tape path adjustment, make the recorder adjustment setting (P. 3-2, 3). Procedure) (1) Referring to the table given below (STEPS 1, 2, 3), play back the tracking master (DY9-1345-000) for tape path adjustment. At STEP 2, perform tracking shift by adjusting DT in a range of F0 to FF so that the RF envelope will be 70%. (2) After adjustment, restore tracking shift setting to normal according to the following table (STEPS 4 : P.OFF). ST EP PROCEDURE MONIT OR Microcomputer operation T RACKING T APE CS Function MD ADDR DT 1 1) Play back the tracking tape. 2 1) Set up tracking shift. 2-1 1) Make the setting shown at right. 0 00 ST 9FE7 F2 2) Perform storing. RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) 3) Perform 70% tracking shift by ST ↑ ↑ ↑ F0~FF T he amount of tracking shift is changed. adjusting DT in a range of F0 to FF. 4) Perform storing. RD ↑ ↑ ↑ ↑ (press the PAUSE button.) * DT 00 in tracking shift released 3 1) Perform tape path adjustment with the RF envelope in 70% tracking shift state. 4 1) Select the normal mode. 2) T urn off power to the main unit. 4-48 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT Copy the chart on a transparent film. Trim and attach the transparent chart on a vectorscope display. Color balance adjustment chart ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A FR 1st MI-COM only NTSC R-Y R BURST B-Y Ye FR 2nd microcomputer and subsequent ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NTSC R-Y R BURST B-Y Ye 4-49 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CHAPTER 4. DISASSEMBLING ADJUSTMENT Copy the chart on a transparent film. Trim and attach the transparent chart on a vectorscope display. Color balance adjustment chart ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NTSC R-Y R Ye B-Y BURST 4-50 CHAPTER 5. PARTS LIST CONTENTS EXPLODED VIEWS Casing Parts Section ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-2 Front Cover Unit Section ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-4 Left Cover Unit Section-1 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-6 Left Cover Unit Section-2 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-8 Right Cover Unit Section-1 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-10 Right Cover Unit Section-2 -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-12 LCD Unit Section -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-14 Rear Cover Unit Section ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-16 CVF Unit Section -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-18 Recorder Unit Section --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-20 Camera Unit Section ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-22 Lens Unit Section -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-24 Mechanical Chassis Section-1 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-26 Mechanical Chassis Section-2 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-28 Mechanical Chassis Section-3 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-30 Mechanical Chassis Section-4 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-32 Accessory Section-1 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-34 Accessory Section-2 ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-36 FUSE Replacement Instruction ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-38 ELECTRICAL PARTS LIST ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-39 PARTS LIST ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-40 CAUTION 1. Especially critical parts in the power circuit block should not be replaced with other marks. Critical parts are marked with in this electrical parts list. 5-1 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Casing Parts Section 1 LEFT COVER UNIT REAR COVER UNIT 2×4 3 5×3 1 5 1 FRONT COVER UNIT 4 1 1×3 1×2 8 7 5 6 CAMERA/ LENS/ RECORDER UNIT 1×2 RIGHT COVER UNIT 1 5-2 1 6 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 XA1-7170-307 XA1-3170-507 DA2-0436-000 D52-0220-000 XA4-9170-457 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 F F B B F 13 4 1 1 5 SCREW SCREW SHOE, ACCESSORY CAP, LENS SCREW DESCRIPTION 6 7 8 XA1-7170-407 DA3-0299-000 DY1-8532-000 DY1-8534-000 DY1-8535-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C C 2 1 1 1 1 SCREW CUSHION PCB ASS’Y, JACK PCB ASS’Y, JACK PCB ASS’Y, JACK 5-3 REMARKS NEW ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Front Cover Unit Section 3×2 1 3×3 2 4 8 7 6 5 5-4 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY DA3-0274-000 DA3-0281-000 DY1-8537-000 DY1-8538-000 DY1-8539-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B B B B 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, L JACK COVER, L JACK COVER ASS’Y, FRONT COVER ASS’Y, FRONT COVER ASS’Y, FRONT ZR70 ZR60 ZR70 ZR65 ZR60 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW A NEW MC A NEW MC A NEW A NEW 5 XA4-9170-457 DY1-8504-000 DY1-8516-000 DY1-8521-000 DY1-8503-000 000 000 000 000 000 F B B B B 5 1 1 1 1 SCREW LENS RING ASS’Y LENS RING ASS’Y LENS RING ASS’Y COVER ASS’Y, F JACK ZR70 ZR65 ZR60 ZR70 MC A MC A A MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW 000 000 000 000 000 B B C C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER ASS’Y, F JACK COVER ASS’Y, F JACK SHIELD, MIC MIC ASS’Y RUBBER, MIC ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 6 7 8 DY1-8515-000 DY1-8520-000 DA3-0267-000 DF1-5033-000 DA3-0265-000 NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 1 2 3 4 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-5 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Left Cover Unit Section-1 *1 1 2 4 3 *1 3×2 6 5 7 8 3×2 12 9 13 10 11×2 *1 : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A ONLY 5-6 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 DA3-0236-000 DA3-0249-000 XA4-9170-457 DG3-0055-000 DG3-0056-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 B C F B B 1 1 5(4) 1 1 DESCRIPTION 5 6 7 8 9 XA4-9170-409 WR1-5083-000 DA3-0330-000 DA3-0248-000 DA3-0234-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 SCREW SPEAKER CUSHION PLATE, C SUPPORT PLATE, C LOCK 10 11 12 13 DA3-0186-000 XA1-7170-307 XA4-7170-407 DA3-0235-000 000 000 000 000 C F F B 1 2 1 1 BASE, TRIPOD SCREW SCREW KNOB, CASSETTE OPEN KNOB, CHANGE PLATE, CHANGE SCREW OPERATION KEY ASS’Y OPERATION KEY ASS’Y 5-7 REMARKS ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW *( )ZR60 A ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Left Cover Unit Section-2 1 3 4 A 2×2 5 2×2 7 8 9 2 A 6 7×3 5-8 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 CLASS Q’TY DA3-0240-000 XA1-7170-257 DA3-0226-000 DA3-0225-000 DA3-0294-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C F B B B 1 5 1 1 1 STRAP, SCREW COVER, COVER, COVER, DESCRIPTION DA3-0296-000 DA3-0239-000 DF1-5005-000 XA4-9170-409 DY1-8502-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C F C 1 1 1 4 1 COVER, LEFT SHAFT, GRIP BELT CASSETTE ARM ASS’Y SCREW PCB ASS’Y, EJECT ZR60 A DA3-0301-000 000 DA3-0303-000 000 DA3-0306-000 000 C C C 1 1 1 LABEL, NAME LABEL, NAME LABEL, NAME ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 5-9 REMARKS HAND CASSETTE LEFT LEFT NEW ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Right Cover Unit Section-1 1 RIGHT COVER UNIT 2 3 5×2 4 *1 LCD UNIT 6×2 *1 : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A ONLY 5-10 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 2 3 4 DA2-1650-000 DA3-0332-000 DA3-0185-000 DA3-0180-000 DA3-0182-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C B B C 1 1 1 1 1 CUSHION CUSHION COVER, LI BATT COVER, CARD SHAFT, CARD COVER 5 6 XA1-7170-407 000 XA4-9170-457 000 F F 2 2 SCREW SCREW 1 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-11 REMARKS ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Right Cover Unit Section-2 1 18 7 *1 6 11 2 8 9 10 2×2 4 12 1×2 17×4 16 3 2×2 19 *2 5 13 15 5 *1 : ZR70 MC A ONLY *2 : ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A ONLY 5 14 5-12 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 XA4-9170-557 XA1-7170-207 DA3-0181-000 DY1-8533-000 DY1-8536-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 F F C C C 3 5(4) 1 1 1 DESCRIPTION 5 6 7 8 9 XA4-9170-457 DG3-0058-000 DA3-0176-000 DA3-0193-000 DA3-0179-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C B 3 1 1 1 1 SCREW BACKLIGHT ASS’Y, R KEY ZR70 MC A HOLDER, LCD LOCK SPRING, LCD LIFT LIFTER, LCD NEW NEW NEW NEW 10 11 12 DA3-0192-000 DA3-0175-000 DY1-8505-000 DY1-8517-000 DY1-8522-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C B B B 1 1 1 1 1 SPRING, LCD LOCK LOCK, LCD COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 13 14 15 16 DA3-0178-000 DG3-0042-000 DA3-0191-000 DG3-0037-000 DG3-0049-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C B C C 1 1 1 1 1 KNOB, LCD OPEN PCB ASS’Y, D SW2 KNOB, A-P PCB ASS’Y, CARD PCB ASS’Y, CARD NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR60 A NEW 17 18 19 XA4-9170-407 XA4-7170-407 DA3-0203-000 DA3-0204-000 000 000 000 000 F F C C 4 1 1 1 SCREW SCREW LABEL, FUSE LABEL, FUSE ZR70 MC A ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A SCREW SCREW LOCK, CARD COVER PCB ASS’Y, R-KEY PCB ASS’Y, R-KEY 5-13 REMARKS *( )ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A NEW ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A LCD Unit Section 9 8 10×2 7 6 1×3 5 4 3 2 1 5-14 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL 1 2 3 *1 *2 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 CLASS Q’TY XA1-7170-307 DA3-0263-000 DA3-0284-000 DA3-0287-000 DG3-0039-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 F B B B C 4 1 1 1 1 SCREW COVER, LCD COVER, LCD COVER, LCD PCB ASS’Y, DESCRIPTION DG1-4135-000 WG2-5210-000 DY1-8333-000 DA3-0261-000 DA3-0264-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B B C C 1 1 1 1 1 BACK LIGHT ASS’Y, LCD LCD ASS’Y LCD ASS’Y HOLDER, LCD SHEET, BOTTOM COVER DY1-8507-000 000 DA3-0262-000 000 DA2-0399-000 000 B B C 1 1 2 HINGE ASS’Y COVER, LCD BOTTOM SHEET, LCD TOP TOP TOP LCD *1 : Same quality as the production line. *2 : Free from the pixel dot. 5-15 REMARKS ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Rear Cover Unit Section 8 CVF Unit 3 1 5 7×4 6 8 4 2 1×3 1 5-16 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 XA4-9170-407 DF1-5006-000 DA3-0250-000 DY1-8514-000 DA3-0251-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 F C B C B 5 1 1 1 1 SCREW BATTERY TERMINAL ASS’Y COVER, REAR PCB ASS’Y, DC LEVER, BATTERY EJECT DESCRIPTION NEW NEW NEW NEW 6 7 8 DA3-0256-000 000 XA9-1481-000 000 XA9-1482-000 000 C F F 1 4 2 SPRING SCREW SCREW NEW NEW NEW 5-17 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CVF Unit Section 13 A 16 12 11 15 10 14 9 8 7 1 17 2 18 19 3 17×2 A 6 4×2 5 4×2 5-18 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY DA3-0215-000 DA3-0223-000 DA3-0206-000 DA3-0221-000 DG3-0057-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B B B C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, DUST COVER, DUST COVER, CVF TOP COVER, CVF TOP HINGE ASS’Y, CVF 6 7 XA1-7170-307 DA3-0207-000 DA3-0222-000 DH2-5022-000 DG3-0038-000 000 000 000 000 000 F B B C C 4 1 1 1 1 SCREW COVER, CVF BOTTOM COVER, CVF BOTTOM FPC, CVF-CAC PCB ASS’Y, CVF 8 9 10 11 12 DA3-0218-000 DA3-0217-000 DA3-0219-000 WG2-5241-000 DA3-0216-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 REFLECTOR, CVF CUSHION, CVF PANEL DIFFUSER, CVF LCD ASS’Y, CVF PLATE, MASK NEW NEW NEW 13 14 15 16 17 DA3-0208-000 YN1-3111-000 DA3-0211-000 DA3-0212-000 XA4-9170-457 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C F 1 1 1 1 3 COVER, CVF INNER LENS, EYEPIECE HOLDER, CVF LENS RUBBER, EYE PIECE SCREW NEW NEW NEW NEW 18 19 DA3-0210-000 000 DA2-1840-000 000 C C 1 1 KNOB, CVF RUBBER, CVF KNOB NEW 1 2 3 4 5 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-19 REMARKS ZR70 ZR60 ZR70 ZR60 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW A NEW MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW A NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Recorder Unit Section CAMERA/LENS UNIT 1 4×3 12×2 5 6×3 7 9 2 3 12×3 11 8 10 12 5-20 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 DY1-8499-000 DA1-9903-000 DA3-0160-000 DA1-9779-000 DA2-0314-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 3 1 RECORDER UNIT, DMC III LABEL, S CHASSIS HOLDER, RECORDER RUBBER, INSULATION SPRING, PLATE 6 7 8 9 XA9-1167-000 DA3-0161-000 DA3-0162-000 DY1-8510-000 DY1-8518-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C C 3 1 1 1 1 SCREW SHIELD CASE, HA SHIELD CASE, PM 1 PCB ASS’Y, MAIN PCB ASS’Y, MAIN DY1-8524-000 DA3-0163-000 DY1-8512-000 XA1-7170-307 000 000 000 000 C C C F 1 1 1 6 PCB ASS’Y, MAIN SHIELD CASE, PM 2 PCB ASS’Y, CAC SCREW 10 11 12 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-21 REMARKS NEW ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Camera Unit Section 1 *1 1 9 2 3 10×2 8 7 *2 4 LENS UNIT 6 5 11 13 12 14×3 15×3 5-22 *1, 2 : ZR70 MC A ONLY ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 2 3 4 DG1-7296-000 DA2-1645-000 XA9-1349-000 DA2-1622-000 DH2-5026-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C F C C 1 1 1 1 1 SHOE CONNECTOR ASS’Y SPACER, SHOE SCREW RUBBER, INSULATION FPC, AAS-CAC 5 6 7 8 9 DA2-1641-000 DH9-0877-000 DA2-1526-000 DY1-8508-000 DG3-0043-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B C B C 1 1 1 1 1 RUBBER, LENS FILTER, IR RUBBER, INSULATION CCD ASS’Y PCB ASS’Y, CCD 10 11 12 13 14 XA4-9170-607 DH2-5025-000 DA3-0165-000 DA3-0164-000 DA2-1524-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C C 2 1 1 1 3 SCREW FPC, CCD-CAC CUSHION, CCD SHEET, SHIELD RUBBER, INSULATION 15 XA9-1294-000 000 F 3 SCREW 1 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-23 REMARKS ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A ZR70 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Lens Unit Section (6)×2 (8) 10 (5) (8) (7) (7) (4) (6)×2 (2) (3) (1)×3 5-24 (9) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 XA4-9170-607 YH8-0122-000 YG9-6000-000 YG9-5999-000 YG1-0154-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 F C C C C 3 1 1 1 1 SCREW IG METER UNIT SHAFT, PZ SHAFT, AF MOTOR, AF DESCRIPTION 6 7 8 9 10 XA4-9170-457 YG9-6001-000 XA4-9170-357 YG1-0153-000 DG1-4518-000 000 000 000 000 000 F C F C B 4 2 2 1 1 SCREW PHOTO, INTERRUPTER SCREW MOTOR, PZ LENS ASS’Y 5-25 REMARKS NEW NEW DMC III Mechanical Chassis Section-1 1 3 9 3×3 2 4 5 7 6 8 5-26 DMC III MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY DESCRIPTION 1 2 3 4 5 DG1-4506-000 XA1-7140-147 DA2-2138-000 DY1-8500-000 DA2-2139-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 B C C E C 1 1 4 1 1 COMPARTMENT ASS’Y, CASSETTE SCREW, CROSS-RECESS, PH SCREW DRUM ASS’Y WASHER NEW 6 7 8 9 DF1-1703-000 DA2-2116-000 DA2-2115-000 DY1-8501-000 000 000 000 000 C C C B 1 1 1 1 IDLER ASS’Y SPRING, COIL (DRUM) SCREW CHASSIS ASS’Y, SLIDE NEW NEW NEW NEW 5-27 REMARKS NEW NEW NEW DMC III Mechanical Chassis Section-2 1 3 2 1 4 9 5 6 11 10 7 8 12 6 13 5-28 DMC III MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 DA2-0645-000 DG1-4504-000 DS1-0193-000 DF1-1693-000 DF1-1694-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 2 1 1 1 1 WASHER REEL ASS’Y, S SPRING, COIL (TENSION) BRAKE ASS’Y, TENSION RELEASE ASS’Y, TENSION DESCRIPTION NEW NEW NEW NEW 6 7 8 9 10 DA2-2139-000 DF1-1704-000 DS1-0199-000 DG1-4505-000 DA2-2220-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 2 1 1 1 1 WASHER BRAKE ASS’Y, S SPRING, COIL (S BRAKE) REEL ASS’Y, T LEVER, EJECT NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 11 12 13 DA2-2238-000 000 DS1-0198-000 000 DF1-1695-000 000 C C C 1 1 1 BRAKE, MAIN T SPRING, COIL (T BRAKE) REVIEW ARM ASS’Y NEW NEW NEW 5-29 REMARKS DMC III Mechanical Chassis Section-3 1 2×2 (5) (4) 3 8 (6) 2×3 9 2×2 (7) 11 12 13 2 10 5-30 DMC III MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 DG1-4502-000 DA2-2261-000 DG1-4497-000 DF1-1687-000 DF1-1688-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 8 1 1 1 MOTOR ASS’Y, LOADING SCREW GUIDE RAIL ASS’Y ROLLER ASS’Y, GUIDE S ROLLER ASS’Y, GUIDE T DESCRIPTION NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 6 7 8 9 10 DA2-0780-000 DF1-1686-000 DA2-2259-000 DG1-4503-000 XA1-7140-147 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 SCREW DRUM BASE ASS’Y SCREW MOTOR ASS’Y, CAPSTAN SCREW, CROSS-RECESS, PH NEW NEW NEW 11 12 13 DG1-4500-000 000 DA2-2139-000 000 DS1-0192-000 000 C C C 1 1 1 ROLLER ASS’Y, PINCH WASHER SPRING, COIL (PINCH) NEW NEW NEW 5-31 REMARKS DMC III Mechanical Chassis Section-4 1 3 8 4 9 5 2 6 7 10 5-32 DMC III MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 DA2-2191-000 XA1-7140-147 DA2-2196-000 DA2-2197-000 DA2-2190-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 LEVER, CAM SCREW, CROSS-RECESS, PH BELT, TIMING GEAR, PULLEY GEAR, CONNECT DESCRIPTION NEW 6 7 8 9 10 DA2-2140-000 DA2-2188-000 DA2-2139-000 DA2-2195-000 DG1-4501-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 WASHER GEAR, WHEEL WASHER GEAR, CAPSTAN CHASSIS ASS’Y, MAIN NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 5-33 REMARKS NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Accessory Section-1 CG-570 N.S. (Product available) N.S. (Product available) CA-570 1 CB-570 N.S. (Product available) 2 SDC-8M N.S. (Commercially availabel. Make copy sample pictures if necessary.) JPN A E PLUG TYPE B AS 3 N.S. (Product available) BP-511/512/522/535 WL-D79A WL-D80A 5 WIDE ATTACHMENT 4 ZR70 MC A ONLY 5-34 (7) (6) ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 DY1-8531-000 D82-0642-000 D55-0170-000 DY1-8242-000 DY1-8303-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 DC CABLE CORD, AC(A) WIDE ATTACHMENT COVER, TERMINAL BP-511(BROWN) COVER, TERMINAL BP-522(GRAY) 5 D83-0622-000 000 C 1 WL-79A WIRELESS CONTROLLER 6 D83-0652-000 000 DY1-8528-000 000 DY1-8121-000 000 C C C 1 1 1 WL-80A WIRELESS CONTROLLER COVER BATTERY COVER BATTERY ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A ZR60A WL-D79A WL-D80A DY1-8530-000 000 DY1-8119-000 000 C C 1 1 LABEL, WIRELESS CONTROLLER(A) LABEL, WIRELESS CONTROLLRE(A) WL-D79A WL-D80A 7 PART NO. DESCRIPTION 5-35 REMARKS PLUG TYPE A ZR70 MC A BP-511/512 BP-522/535 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A Accessory Section-2 N.S. (Product available) N.S. (Product available) WD-30.5 DM-50 5 2 4 1 N.S. (Product available) TL-30.5 5 N.S. (Product available) VL-3 IFC-300PCU N.S. (Product available) 4 N.S. (Product available) FS-30.5 3 6 SS-800 5-36 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MECHANICAL PARTS SYMBOL CLASS Q’TY 1 2 3 4 5 DY1-8246-000 DY1-8247-000 DY1-8245-000 DY4-4764-000 DY4-4765-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C C E C C 1 1 1 1 1 WIND SCREEN, FRONT WIND SCREEN, REAR LAMP, HAROGEN CAP, CONVERTER(FRONT) CAP, CONVERTER(REAR) DESCRIPTION 6 D81-1430-000 000 C 1 SHOULDER STRAP SS-800 5-37 REMARKS ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A FUSE Replacement Instruction CAUTION - For continued protection against risk of fire, replace FU1801, FU3201, FU3204, FU3205 only with same type : 494001 1.0A-50V FUSE and replace FU3202, FU3203 only same type : 49401.5 1.5A-50V FUSE MANUFACTURER : LITTELFUSE. CN300 CN303 CN301 CN2000 CN302 CN891 CN102 IC300 CN101 IC103 IC301 CN2101 IC100 CN100 IC1802 IC102 CN990 IC2100 IC3204 CN3202 CN1101 CN3201 CN2900 CN2501 MAIN P.C.B. FU1801 FU3205 FU3201 FU3202 FU3204 FU3203 5-38 ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A ELECTRICAL PARTS SYMBOL PART NO. MAIN P.C.B ASS’Y CN100 VS1-6596-033 CN101 VS1-5988-010 CN300 VS1-5817-011 CN302 VS1-7005-018 CLASS Q’TY DESCRIPTION 000 000 000 000 C C C C 1 1 1 1 CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR 33p 10p 11p 18p CN303 CN891 CN2101 CN2501 FU1801 VS1-6851-021 VS1-5988-009 VS1-6851-039 WS1-6098-000 VD7-2241-001 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 CONNECTOR 21p CONNECTOR 9p CONNECTOR 39p CONNECTOR, DV CHIP FUSE FU3201 FU3202 FU3203 FU3204 FU3205 VD7-2241-001 VD7-2241-501 VD7-2241-501 VD7-2241-001 VD7-2241-001 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 CHIP CHIP CHIP CHIP CHIP CAC P.C.B ASS’Y CN1001 VS1-6228-015 000 CN1201 VS1-6851-021 000 CN1501 VS1-6851-023 000 C C C 1 1 1 CONNECTOR 15p CONNECTOR 21p CONNECTOR 23p JACK P.C.B ASS’Y CN1 WS1-5716-000 CN2 WS1-5524-000 CN3 WS1-6004-000 CN4 WS1-6104-000 000 000 000 000 C C C C 1 1 1 1 JACK, JACK, JACK, JACK, VS1-6851-039 000 C 1 CONNECTOR 39p CN7 5-39 REMARKS NEW NEW NEW NEW FUSE FUSE FUSE FUSE FUSE MIC MINI AV USB S-VIDEO NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A PARTS LIST PAGE CLASS Q’TY 3 35 37 35 35 D52-0220-000 D55-0170-000 D81-1430-000 D82-0642-000 D83-0622-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 CAP, LENS NEW WIDE ATTACHMENT ZR70 MC A SHOULDER STRAP SS-800 CORD, AC(A) PLUG TYPE A WL-79A WIRELESS CONTROLLER ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A 35 21 21 21 15 D83-0652-000 DA1-9779-000 DA1-9903-000 DA2-0314-000 DA2-0399-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 3 1 1 2 WL-80A WIRELESS CONTROLLER ZR60A RUBBER, INSULATION LABEL, S CHASSIS SPRING, PLATE SHEET, LCD 3 29 31 23 23 DA2-0436-000 DA2-0645-000 DA2-0780-000 DA2-1524-000 DA2-1526-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C C 1 2 1 3 1 SHOE, ACCESSORY WASHER SCREW RUBBER, INSULATION RUBBER, INSULATION 23 23 23 11 19 DA2-1622-000 DA2-1641-000 DA2-1645-000 DA2-1650-000 DA2-1840-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 RUBBER, RUBBER, SPACER, CUSHION RUBBER, DA2-2115-000 DA2-2116-000 DA2-2138-000 DA2-2139-000 DA2-2140-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 4 5 1 SCREW SPRING, COIL (DRUM) SCREW WASHER WASHER NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 33 33 33 33 33 DA2-2188-000 DA2-2190-000 DA2-2191-000 DA2-2195-000 DA2-2196-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 GEAR, WHEEL GEAR, CONNECT LEVER, CAM GEAR, CAPSTAN BELT, TIMING NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 33 29 29 31 31 DA2-2197-000 DA2-2220-000 DA2-2238-000 DA2-2259-000 DA2-2261-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 8 GEAR, PULLEY LEVER, EJECT BRAKE, MAIN T SCREW SCREW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 21 21 21 21 23 DA3-0160-000 DA3-0161-000 DA3-0162-000 DA3-0163-000 DA3-0164-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 HOLDER, RECORDER SHIELD CASE, HA SHIELD CASE, PM 1 SHIELD CASE, PM 2 SHEET, SHIELD NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 23 13 13 13 13 DA3-0165-000 DA3-0175-000 DA3-0176-000 DA3-0178-000 DA3-0179-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C B B 1 1 1 1 1 CUSHION, CCD LOCK, LCD HOLDER, LCD LOCK KNOB, LCD OPEN LIFTER, LCD NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 11 13 11 11 7 DA3-0180-000 DA3-0181-000 DA3-0182-000 DA3-0185-000 DA3-0186-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C B C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, CARD LOCK, CARD COVER SHAFT, CARD COVER COVER, LI BATT BASE, TRIPOD 13 13 13 13 13 DA3-0191-000 DA3-0192-000 DA3-0193-000 DA3-0203-000 DA3-0204-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 KNOB, A-P SPRING, LCD LOCK SPRING, LCD LIFT LABEL, FUSE LABEL, FUSE ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A 19 19 19 19 19 DA3-0206-000 DA3-0207-000 DA3-0208-000 DA3-0210-000 DA3-0211-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B B C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, CVF TOP COVER, CVF BOTTOM COVER, CVF INNER KNOB, CVF HOLDER, CVF LENS ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW 27 27 27 27,29,31,33 33 DESCRIPTION 5-40 INSULATION LENS SHOE REMARKS ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A ZR70 MC A CVF KNOB ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A PARTS LIST PAGE CLASS Q’TY 19 19 19 19 19 DA3-0212-000 DA3-0215-000 DA3-0216-000 DA3-0217-000 DA3-0218-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C B C C C 1 1 1 1 1 RUBBER, EYE PIECE COVER, DUST PLATE, MASK CUSHION, CVF PANEL REFLECTOR, CVF DESCRIPTION NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW 19 19 19 19 9 DA3-0219-000 DA3-0221-000 DA3-0222-000 DA3-0223-000 DA3-0225-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B B B B 1 1 1 1 1 DIFFUSER, CVF COVER, CVF TOP COVER, CVF BOTTOM COVER, DUST COVER, LEFT ZR60 ZR60 ZR60 ZR70 9 7 7 7 9 DA3-0226-000 DA3-0234-000 DA3-0235-000 DA3-0236-000 DA3-0239-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C B B C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, CASSETTE PLATE, C LOCK KNOB, CASSETTE OPEN KNOB, CHANGE SHAFT, GRIP BELT NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW 9 7 7 17 17 DA3-0240-000 DA3-0248-000 DA3-0249-000 DA3-0250-000 DA3-0251-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C B B 1 1 1 1 1 STRAP, PLATE, PLATE, COVER, LEVER, NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW 17 15 15 15 15 DA3-0256-000 DA3-0261-000 DA3-0262-000 DA3-0263-000 DA3-0264-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C B B C 1 1 1 1 1 SPRING HOLDER, LCD COVER, LCD BOTTOM COVER, LCD TOP SHEET, BOTTOM COVER 5 5 5 5 15 DA3-0265-000 DA3-0267-000 DA3-0274-000 DA3-0281-000 DA3-0284-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C B B B 1 1 1 1 1 RUBBER, MIC SHIELD, MIC COVER, L JACK COVER, L JACK COVER, LCD TOP NEW NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR60 A NEW ZR65 MC A NEW 15 9 9 3 9 DA3-0287-000 DA3-0294-000 DA3-0296-000 DA3-0299-000 DA3-0301-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B B C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, LCD TOP COVER, LEFT COVER, LEFT CUSHION LABEL, NAME ZR60 A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 9 9 7 11 31 DA3-0303-000 DA3-0306-000 DA3-0330-000 DA3-0332-000 DF1-1686-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 LABEL, NAME LABEL, NAME CUSHION CUSHION DRUM BASE ASS’Y ZR65 MC A ZR60 A 31 31 29 29 29 DF1-1687-000 DF1-1688-000 DF1-1693-000 DF1-1694-000 DF1-1695-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 ROLLER ASS’Y, GUIDE S ROLLER ASS’Y, GUIDE T BRAKE ASS’Y, TENSION RELEASE ASS’Y, TENSION REVIEW ARM ASS’Y NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 27 29 9 17 5 DF1-1703-000 DF1-1704-000 DF1-5005-000 DF1-5006-000 DF1-5033-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 IDLER ASS’Y BRAKE ASS’Y, S CASSETTE ARM ASS’Y BATTERY TERMINAL ASS’Y MIC ASS’Y NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 15 31 31 33 31 DG1-4135-000 DG1-4497-000 DG1-4500-000 DG1-4501-000 DG1-4502-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 BACK LIGHT ASS’Y, LCD GUIDE RAIL ASS’Y ROLLER ASS’Y, PINCH CHASSIS ASS’Y, MAIN MOTOR ASS’Y, LOADING NEW NEW NEW NEW 31 29 29 27 25 DG1-4503-000 DG1-4504-000 DG1-4505-000 DG1-4506-000 DG1-4518-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C B B 1 1 1 1 1 MOTOR ASS’Y, CAPSTAN REEL ASS’Y, S REEL ASS’Y, T COMPARTMENT ASS’Y, CASSETTE LENS ASS’Y NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 5-41 HAND C SUPPORT CHANGE REAR BATTERY EJECT REMARKS A A A MC A ZR70 MC A ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A PARTS LIST PAGE *2 CLASS Q’TY 23 13 19 15 13 DG1-7296-000 DG3-0037-000 DG3-0038-000 DG3-0039-000 DG3-0042-000 PART NO. 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 SHOE CONNECTOR ASS’Y PCB ASS’Y, CARD PCB ASS’Y, CVF PCB ASS’Y, LCD PCB ASS’Y, D SW2 DESCRIPTION ZR70 MC A ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW 23 13 7 7 19 DG3-0043-000 DG3-0049-000 DG3-0055-000 DG3-0056-000 DG3-0057-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C B B C 1 1 1 1 1 PCB ASS’Y, CCD PCB ASS’Y, CARD OPERATION KEY ASS’Y OPERATION KEY ASS’Y HINGE ASS’Y, CVF NEW ZR60 A NEW ZR70 MC A,ZR65 MC A NEW ZR60 A NEW NEW 13 19 23 23 23 DG3-0058-000 DH2-5022-000 DH2-5025-000 DH2-5026-000 DH9-0877-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C B 1 1 1 1 1 BACKLIGHT ASS’Y, R KEY FPC, CVF-CAC FPC, CCD-CAC FPC, AAS-CAC FILTER, IR ZR70 MC A 31 29 29 29 35 DS1-0192-000 DS1-0193-000 DS1-0198-000 DS1-0199-000 DY1-8119-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 SPRING, COIL (PINCH) SPRING, COIL (TENSION) SPRING, COIL (T BRAKE) SPRING, COIL (S BRAKE) LABEL, WIRELESS CONTROLLRE(A) WL-D80A 35 35 37 37 37 DY1-8121-000 DY1-8242-000 DY1-8245-000 DY1-8246-000 DY1-8247-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C E C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER BATTERY COVER, TERMINAL BP-511(BROWN) BP-511/512 LAMP, HAROGEN WIND SCREEN, FRONT WIND SCREEN, REAR 35 15 21 27 27 DY1-8303-000 DY1-8333-000 DY1-8499-000 DY1-8500-000 DY1-8501-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B C E B 1 1 1 1 1 COVER, TERMINAL BP-522(GRAY) BP-522/535 LCD ASS’Y RECORDER UNIT, DMC III DRUM ASS’Y CHASSIS ASS’Y, SLIDE NEW NEW 9 5 5 13 15 DY1-8502-000 DY1-8503-000 DY1-8504-000 DY1-8505-000 DY1-8507-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B B B B 1 1 1 1 1 PCB ASS’Y, EJECT COVER ASS’Y, F JACK LENS RING ASS’Y COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT HINGE ASS’Y NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 23 21 21 17 5 DY1-8508-000 DY1-8510-000 DY1-8512-000 DY1-8514-000 DY1-8515-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C B 1 1 1 1 1 CCD ASS’Y PCB ASS’Y, MAIN PCB ASS’Y, CAC PCB ASS’Y, DC COVER ASS’Y, F JACK ZR70 MC A NEW NEW ZR65 MC A NEW NEW 5 13 21 5 5 DY1-8516-000 DY1-8517-000 DY1-8518-000 DY1-8520-000 DY1-8521-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B C B B 1 1 1 1 1 LENS RING ASS’Y COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT PCB ASS’Y, MAIN COVER ASS’Y, F JACK LENS RING ASS’Y ZR65 ZR65 ZR65 ZR60 ZR60 NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW 13 21 35 35 35 DY1-8522-000 DY1-8524-000 DY1-8528-000 DY1-8530-000 DY1-8531-000 000 000 000 000 000 B C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER ASS’Y, RIGHT PCB ASS’Y, MAIN COVER BATTERY LABEL, WIRELESS CONTROLLER(A) DC CABLE ZR60 A ZR60 A WL-D79A WL-D79A 3 13 3 3 13 DY1-8532-000 DY1-8533-000 DY1-8534-000 DY1-8535-000 DY1-8536-000 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 1 1 1 PCB PCB PCB PCB PCB ZR70 ZR70 ZR65 ZR60 ZR65 5 5 5 37 37 DY1-8537-000 DY1-8538-000 DY1-8539-000 DY4-4764-000 DY4-4765-000 000 000 000 000 000 B B B C C 1 1 1 1 1 COVER ASS’Y, FRONT COVER ASS’Y, FRONT COVER ASS’Y, FRONT CAP, CONVERTER(FRONT) CAP, CONVERTER(REAR) 5-42 ASS’Y, ASS’Y, ASS’Y, ASS’Y, ASS’Y, JACK R-KEY JACK JACK R-KEY REMARKS ZR70 MC A NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A ZR70 MC A ZR70 MC A MC A MC A MC A A A MC MC MC A MC NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW WL-D80A NEW NEW A A A A,ZR60 A ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW NEW ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A PARTS LIST PAGE CLASS Q’TY VD7-2241-001 VD7-2241-501 VS1-5817-011 VS1-5988-009 VS1-5988-010 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 4 2 1 1 1 CHIP FUSE CHIP FUSE CONNECTOR 11p CONNECTOR 9p CONNECTOR 10p VS1-6228-015 VS1-6596-033 VS1-6851-021 VS1-6851-023 VS1-6851-039 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C C 1 1 2 1 2 CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR VS1-7005-018 WG2-5210-000 WG2-5241-000 WR1-5083-000 WS1-5524-000 000 000 000 000 000 C B C C C 1 1 1 1 1 CONNECTOR 18p LCD ASS’Y LCD ASS’Y, CVF SPEAKER JACK, MINI AV 3 WS1-5716-000 WS1-6004-000 WS1-6098-000 WS1-6104-000 XA1-3170-507 000 000 000 000 000 C C C C F 1 1 1 1 4 JACK, MIC JACK, USB CONNECTOR, DV JACK, S-VIDEO SCREW 27,31,33 13 9 3,7,15,19,21 3,11 XA1-7140-147 XA1-7170-207 XA1-7170-257 XA1-7170-307 XA1-7170-407 000 000 000 000 000 C F F F F 3 5(4) 5 29 4 7,13 25 13,17 7,9 3,5,7,11,13,19,25 XA4-7170-407 XA4-9170-357 XA4-9170-407 XA4-9170-409 XA4-9170-457 000 000 000 000 000 F F F F F 2(1) 2 9 5 27(26) SCREW SCREW SCREW SCREW SCREW 13 23,25 21 23 23 XA4-9170-557 XA4-9170-607 XA9-1167-000 XA9-1294-000 XA9-1349-000 000 000 000 000 000 F F F F F 3 5 3 3 1 SCREW SCREW SCREW SCREW SCREW 17 17 25 25 25 XA9-1481-000 XA9-1482-000 YG1-0153-000 YG1-0154-000 YG9-5999-000 000 000 000 000 000 F F C C C 4 2 1 1 1 SCREW SCREW MOTOR, PZ MOTOR, AF SHAFT, AF 25 25 25 19 YG9-6000-000 YG9-6001-000 YH8-0122-000 YN1-3111-000 000 000 000 000 C C C C 1 2 1 1 SHAFT, PZ PHOTO, INTERRUPTER IG METER UNIT LENS, EYEPIECE *1 PART NO. 15 19 7 DESCRIPTION REMARKS NEW NEW 15p 33p 21p 23p 39p NEW NEW NEW NEW SCREW, CROSS-RECESS, PH SCREW *( )ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A SCREW SCREW SCREW 5-43 *( )ZR65 MC A,ZR60 A *( )ZR60 A NEW NEW NEW NEW CHAPTER 6. BLOCK DIAGRAMS CONTENTS INTERCONNECTION DIAGRAM BLOCK DIAGRAMS CAMERA SECTION-1 CAMERA SECTION-2 SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION SERVO SECTION AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-2 POWER SUPPLY SECTION LCD P.C.B. SECTION JACK P.C.B. SECTION INTERCONNECTION DIAGRAM LENS UNIT ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A DSW2 P.C.B. TEMP SENS LCD UNIT ZOOM SENS ZOOM MOTOR FOCUS MOTOR LCD FOCUS SENS CN100 1 5 IG METER RKEY P.C.B. JOG FPC 1 CN101 RKEY BACK LIGHT ASS'Y 2 SHOE CONNECTOR ASSEMBLY DMC III MIC UNIT RED BLK ( DIGITAL MECHANICAL CHASSIS III ) SLIDE CHASSIS MAIN CHASSIS DRUM MOTOR VIDEO HEAD LOADING MOTOR CN5 MIC JACK OPERATION KEY UNIT 2 1 CN1 SPEAKER IC1601 AV JACK 1 CN300 21 CN303 1 18 CN891 CN2 CN302 11 1 CN2000 7 1 1 1 9 EJECT SW 38 39 USB JACK JACK P.C.B. CN3 1 CN102 IC103 IC301 IC1101 IC2300 IC2302 IC102 CN990 2 1 4 12 CN701 1 IC2100 S JACK DV JACK CN2501 IC803 A1 B1 CN2900 A10 B10 6 IC3202 IC3203 IC801 CN1101 CN100 BATTERY TERMINAL 32 33 B1 A1 B35 A35 CN4 IC1802 IC2301 1 CN6 10 2 1 IC100 IC1102 39 2 1 CN101 A1 B1 CN2101 CN7 IC1602 A15 B15 IC300 BACK LIGHT CN301 10 1 IC2000 1 CN3202 IC3204 IC3201 1 6 3 CN3201 1 MAIN P.C.B. WP4201 IC4201 WP4202 IC802 1 CN901 LCD P.C.B. 7 1 CN902 12 CN4002 CCD P.C.B. 14 1 HINGE ASS'Y 1 3 1 21 CN1201 1 20 2 IC1701 CN1070 IC903 15 IC902 DC P.C.B. 15 CARD P.C.B. CN1001 2 CN1 1 1 CN903 IC901 24 DC JACK CN4001 IC1202 IC1001 1 1 22 22 23 IC1002 CN1501 2 1 1 32 33 2 CN4101 CN4102 LCD 7 1 2 Metal contact (Pins' face down) 23 22 Metal contact (Pins' face up) 1 IC1501 B1 A1 1 CN4000 CVF P.C.B. CAC P.C.B. 1 12 CN1502 7 : : 1 12 CN1002 Metal contact B35 Metal contact A35 IC1502 SD CARD 1 7 01 Feb. 2003 C CANON INC. 2003 INTERCONNECTION DIAGRAM MAIN P.C.B. CN100 1 GND 2 CARD DAT2 3 CARD CMD 4 CARD DAT3 5 GND 6 DVDD 3V 7 CHAGE LED 8 GND 9 CARD SCK 10 GND 11 GND 12 CARD ACC LED 13 CARD DAT 14 CARD VSS1 15 CARD DAT1 16 VTR UNREG 17 CARD PRO 18 PANEL B/T SW 19 CARD DET 20 KEY AD0 21 LI 3V 22 KEY AD1 23 PAE/GREEN 24 PANEL OPEN SW 25 DIAL CW 26 DIAL CCW 27 KEY AD2 28 KEY AD3 29 P5V 30 KEY LED2 31 KEY LED1 32 KEY LED0 33 KEY LED0 CN101 1 CK 3V 2 ZOOM AD 3 GND 4 PHOTO SW 5 HALF PHOTO SW 6 TAPE/CARD SW 7 GND 8 START/STOP SW 9 VTR PW SW 10 CAM PW SW CN102 A1 MODE RESET A2 EPM A3 CE A4 CNVSS A5 N.C A6 DEBCLK A7 GND A8 DEBUD A9 GND A10 DEBDD A11 GND A12 XDEBEN A13 GND A14 GND A15 E3V+LI3V B1 GND B2 FLASH CLK B3 FLASH RST B4 FLASH RXD1 B5 FLASH TXD1 B6 N.C B7 DVDD3V B8 CG CS B9 EEP/CG CLK B10 EEP/CG SO B11 DOT CLK B12 OSD I0 B13 OSD I1 B14 VIC HD B15 VIC VD CN300 1 W 2 W 3 COIL COM 4 SENS GARD 5 SENS COM 6 DPG 7 DFG 8 V 9 V 10 U 11 U CN301 1 N.C 2 DEW − 3 DEW + 4 LOAD (−) 5 LOAD (−) 6 MSW SENS 7 MSW VCC 8 MSW VSS 9 LOAD (+) 10 LOAD (+) CN302 1 U COIL 2 U COIL 3 W COIL 4 W COIL 5 V COIL 6 V COIL 7 CH− 8 W− 9 W+ 10 C H + 11 U + 12 U − 13 V + 14 V − 15 CFG2 16 CFG GND 17 CFG VCC 18 CFG1 CN303 1 BOT E 2 BOT C 3 MIC GND 4 MIC3 5 REC PRF 6 MIC2 7 MIC1 8 T IN − 9 T OUT − 10 T IN + 11 T OUT + 12 C IN 13 CIN GND 14 LED A 15 LED K 16 S IN − 17 S OUT − 18 S IN + 19 S OUT + 20 EOT E 21 EOT C CN701 1 MIC GND R 2 INT MIC R 3 MIC GND L 4 INT MIC L MAIN P.C.B. MAIN P.C.B. CAC P.C.B. CN891 1 SHOE UNREG 2 SHOE UNREG 3 POW GND 4 POW GND 5 ID-1 6 SPACK ON 7 ADV MIC GND 8 ADV MIC L 9 ADV MIC R CN990 1 LCD 3V 2 LCD 5V 3 LCD 8.5V 4 LCD 15V 5 KCD −10V 6 GND 7 MO GND 8 VTR UNREG 9 PANEL XOE 10 PANEL LCK 11 LCD CS 12 LCD EEP CS CN1101 A1 GND A2 RAWDATA (6) A3 RAWDATA (5) A4 RAWDATA (4) A5 RAWDATA (3) A6 RAWDATA (2) A7 GND A8 PWM FA A9 PWM FB A10 PWM ZA A11 PWM ZB A12 Z PSB A13 F PSB A14 Z RES SW A15 F RES SW A16 GND A17 MO GND A18 MO GND A19 P5V A20 P5V A21 VF R A22 VF G A23 VF B A24 GND A25 CSYNC A26 GND A27 EVF BL ON A28 EVF 8.5V A29 LCD 3V A30 EVF EEP CS A31 LCD EEP SOUT A32 EVF SEN A33 LCD EEP SCK A34 EVF EEP SIN A35 EVF 3V ON B1 GND B2 RAWDATA(7) B3 RAWDATA (8) B4 RAWDATA(9) B5 RAWDATA(10) B6 RAWDATA(11) B7 GND B8 GND B9 GND B10 DSP CLK B11 GND B12 AGC CS B13 CAM SO B14 CAM SCK B15 TG RST B16 VGATE B17 XTGHD B18 XTGVD B19 XSG B20 CAM 3V B21 CAM 3V B22 IRIS 3V B23 CCD 15V B24 CCD −7V B25 DA LOAD B26 LED RET B27 I SW B28 P GY OUT B29 Y GY OUT B30 TEMP B31 P GYRO B32 Y GYRO B33 I ENC B34 IRIS CL B35 IRIS OP CN2000 1 HA GND 2 H1A 3 H1B 4 HA GND 5 H2A 6 H2B 7 HA GND CN2101 1 MIC GND 2 EXT L 3 EXT P DET 4 EXT R 5 MIC GND 6 MIC GND 7 P5V 8 CAM LED 9 AV GND 10 AV GND 11 V I/O/HP R 12 AV DET 13 AV GND 14 AV R 15 AV L/HP L 16 AV GND 17 AV GND 18 P GY OUT 19 RMC IN 20 CAM 3V 21 SP + 22 SP − 23 V BUS 24 GND 25 GND 26 D − 27 D + 28 GND 29 GND 30 Y GY OUT 31 EJECT SW 32 GND 33 S DET 34 Y I/O 35 YC GND 36 YC GND 37 C I/O 38 YC GND 39 N.C CN2900 A1 V I/O A2 GND A3 VTR POW SW A4 T/C POW SW A5 CAM POW SW A6 FCH O A7 TCK A8 SWP A9 GND A10 PBRF B1 N.C B2 MODE RESET B3 VTR ON IC3201 B4 N.C B5 MIC2 B6 MIC3 B7 TRST B8 TMS B9 TDI B10 TDO CN3201 1 DC − 2 DC + 3 DC J SW CN3202 1 BATT E3 2 BATT INFO AD 3 BATT − 4 BATT − 5 BATT + 6 BATT + CN1001 1 VSUB 2 V2 3 V1 4 V3 5 V4 6 GND 7 RESET 8 H1 9 H2 10 GND 11 CCD VH 15V 12 CCD VL −7.5V 13 GND 14 CCD OUT 15 GND CN1002 A1 GND A2 RAWDATA (6) A3 RAWDATA (5) A4 RAWDATA (4) A5 RAWDATA (3) A6 RAWDATA (2) A7 GND A8 PWM FA A9 PWM FB A10 PWM ZA A11 PWM ZB A12 Z PSB A13 F PSB A14 Z RES SW A15 F RES SW A16 GND A17 MO GND A18 MO GND A19 P5V A20 P5V A21 VF R A22 VF G A23 VF B A24 GND A25 CSYNC A26 GND A27 EVF BL ON A28 EVF 8.5V A29 LCD 3V A30 EVF EEP CS A31 LCD EEP SOUT A32 EVF SEN A33 LCD EEP SCK A34 EVF EEP SIN A35 EVF 3V ON B1 GND B2 RAWDATA(7) B3 RAWDATA (8) B4 RAW\DATA(9) B5 RAWDATA(10) B6 RAWDATA(11) B7 GND B8 GND B9 GND B10 DSP CLK B11 GND B12 AGC CS B13 CAM SO B14 CAM SCK B15 TG RST B16 VGATE B17 XTGHD B18 XTGVD B19 XSG B20 CAM 3V B21 CAM 3V B22 IRIS 3V B23 CCD 15V B24 CCD −7V B25 DA LOAD B26 LED RET B27 I SW B28 P GY OUT B29 Y GY OUT B30 TEMP B31 P GYRO B32 Y GYRO B33 I ENC B34 IRIS CL B35 IRIS OP CN1201 1 DRIVE (+) 2 DRIVE (−) 3 HALL IN (+) 4 HALL OUT (+) 5 HALL IN(−) 6 HALL OUT (−) 7 GND 8 FOCUS A 9 FOCUS B 10 FOCUS-B 11 FOCUS-A 12 FOCUS VCC 13 ZOOM LED 14 ZOOM SENS 15 TEMP 16 FOCUS LED 17 FOCUS SENS 18 ZOOM-B 19 ZOOM B 20 ZOOM-A 21 ZOOM A CN1501 1 XSTH 2 STH 3 CKH1 4 VSS 5 CKH2 6 VDD 7 G 8 R 9 B 10 VSS 11 DSG 12 XDSG 13 DSD 14 VBB 15 ENB 16 XENB 17 XSTV 18 STV 19 CKV2 20 CKV1 21 COM 22 BL5V 23 BL5V CN1502 1 LCD EEP SOUT 2 LCD EEP SCK 3 EVF EEP SIN 4 C SYNC 5 PANEL R 6 PANEL G 7 PANEL B JACK P.C.B. CN5 1 SP + 2 SP − CN6 1 GND 2 EJECT SW CN7 1 YC GND 2 C I/O 3 YC GND 4 YC GND 5 Y I/O 6 S DET 7 GND 8 EJECT SW 9 Y GY OUT 10 GND 11 GND 12 D + 13 D − 14 GND 15 GND 16 VBUS 17 SP − 18 SP + 19 CAM 3V 20 RMC IN 21 P GY OUT 22 AV GND 23 AV GND 24 AV L/HP L 25 AV R 26 AV GND 27 AV DET 28 V I/O/HP R 29 AV GND 30 AV GND 31 CAM LED 32 P5V 33 MIC GND 34 MIC GND 35 EXT R 36 EXT P DET 37 EXT L 38 MIC GND 39 N.C CARD P.C.B. CN4000 1 MMC RSV 2 MMC CMD 3 MMC VSS1 4 MMC VDD 5 MMC CLK 6 MMC VSS1 7 MMC DAT 8 MMC DAT1 9 MMC DAT2 10 CARD PRO 11 GND 12 CARD DET CN4001 1 KEY LED0 2 KEY LED1 3 KEY LED2 4 P5V 5 KEY AD3 6 KEY AD2 7 DIAL CCW 8 DIAL CW 9 PANEL OPEN SW 10 PAE/GREEN 11 KEY AD1 12 LI 3V 13 KEY AD0 14 CARD DET 15 PANEL B/T SW 16 CARD PRO 17 VTR UNREG 18 CARD DAT1 19 CARD VSS1 20 CARD DAT 21 CARD ACC LED 22 GND 23 GND 24 CARD SCK 25 GND 26 CHAGE LED 27 DVDD 3V 28 GND 29 CARD DAT3 30 CARD CMD 31 CARD DAT2 32 GND 33 GND CN4002 1 MENU 2 GND 3 DIAL CW 4 DIAL CCW 5 DIAL PUSH 6 GND 7 PANEL B/T SW 8 PANEL OPEN SW 9 P5V 10 KEY LED0 11 KEY LED1 12 KEY LED2 13 KEY AD2 14 REW KEY CVF P.C.B. CN4101 1 BL5V 2 COM 3 CKV1 4 CKV2 5 STV 6 XSTV 7 XENB 8 ENB 9 VBB 10 DSD 11 XDSG 12 DSG 13 GND 14 B 15 R 16 G 17 VDD 18 CKH2 19 VSS 20 CKH1 21 STH 22 XSTH 23 XSTH CN4102 1 XSTH 2 STH 3 VSS 4 CKH1 5 CKH2 6 VDD 7 CSH 8 G 9 R 10 B 11 DSG 12 XDSG 13 DSD 14 VBB 15 CSV 16 ENB 17 XENB 18 XSTV 19 STV 20 CKV2 21 CKV1 22 COM LCD P.C.B. CN901 1 LCD EEP SOUT 2 LCD EEP SCK 3 SIN1 4 C SYNC 5 PANEL R 6 PANEL G 7 PANEL B CN902 1 LCD 3V 2 LCD 5V 3 LCD 8.5V 4 LCD 15V 5 LCD −10V 6 GND 7 MO GND 8 VTR UNREG 9 PANEL XOE 10 PANEL LCK 11 LCD CS 12 LCD EEP CS CN903 1 VGL 2 N.C 3 STVR 4 U/D 5 CKV 6 DEV 7 STVL 8 VCC 9 VGH 10 VCOM 11 AVDD 12 STHR 13 L/R 14 N.C 15 VR 16 VG 17 VB 18 GND 19 CPH3 20 CPH2 21 CPH1 22 Q1H 23 OEH 24 STHL RKEY P.C.B. CN100 1 P5V 2 KEY LED0 3 KEY LED1 4 KEY LED2 5 N.C CN101 1 GND 2 PANEL B/T SW CCD P.C.B. CN1070 1 GND 2 CCD OUT 3 GND 4 VL (−7.5V) 5 VH (+15V) 6 GND 7 H2 8 H1 9 RESET 10 GND 11 V4 12 V3 13 V1 14 V2 15 VSUB ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CAMERA SECTION-1 ANALOG VIDEO SIGNAL ZR70MC A, ZR65MC A, ZR60 A DIGITAL VIDEO SIGNAL CCD P.C.B. CAC P.C.B. CCD VL -7.5V CAM 3V P5V 4 V2 3 V3 2 V4 1 VDD 8 VL 11 RG 9 H1 12 H2 13 VOUT 20 VHH VSUB CN1070 VSUB V1 V2 V3 V4 VH (+15V) VL (−7.5V) RESET H1 H2 CCD OUT 15 13 14 12 11 5 4 9 8 7 2 1 2 3 4 5 11 12 7 8 9 14 CN1001 VSUB V2 V1 V3 V4 CCD VH 15V CCD VL -7.5V RESET H1 H2 CCD OUT V2 V1 V3 V4 1 DSUB 3 DV2 5 DV1 IC1001 MN3112SA V-DRIVER 17 DV3 CH1 8 IV1 7 IV2 9 CH1 IV1 IV2 ISUB ISUB 10 IV4 IV4 12 CH2 CH2 13 IV3 IV3 14 18 DV4 RESET CCD VH 15V CCD VL -7.5V H1 H2 CCD OUT 36 CH 1 D0 42 V 1 41 V 2 34 SUB 39 V 4 35 CH 2 40 V 3 27 R 28 H1 31 H2 IC1002 AN12070A TG/CDS/AGC/AD 5 VM 1 8 VM 2 CAM 3V VDD 12 20 CCD SW 26 DVDD3 18 VM 3 FOCUS A FOCUS B TO LENS UNIT 8 9 10 11 18 19 20 21 1 2 3 4 5 6 12 14 15 17 13 16 CN1201 FOCUS A FOCUS B FOCUS −B FOCUS −A ZOOM −B ZOOM B ZOOM −A ZOOM A DRIVE (+) DRIVE (−) HALL IN (+) HALL OUT (+) HALL IN (−) HALL OUT (−) FOCUS VCC ZOOM SENS TEMP FOCUS SENS ZOOM LED FOCUS LED FOCUS −B FOCUS −A ZOOM −B ZOOM B ZOOM −A ZOOM A DRIVE (+) CAM 3V DRIVE (−) HALL IN (+) HALL OUT (+) HALL IN (−) HALL OUT (−) 4 9 OUT 1F OUT 2F 7 OUT 2R 6 OUT 1R IN 1 IC1701 BH6564FV MOTOR DRIVE 3 IN 2 10 IN 3 21 IN 4 15 17 OUT 4R EN 4 14 16 OUT 4F EN 3 22 19 OUT 3R EN 2 11 20 OUT 3F EN 1 2 2 2 35 35 1 1 36 36 3 3 37 37 4 4 34 34 5 5 33 33 6 6 18 18 Q1201 IC1202 BH9910KV IRIS DRIVE 27 27 28 28 19 19 29 DVDD3 PWM FA 32 DVDD3 PWM FB D1 2 D2 3 D3 4 D4 5 D5 6 D6 7 D7 8 D8 9 LCD 3V CAM 3V RAWDATA (2) RAWDATA (3) IRIS 3V CCD 15V CCD −7V RAWDATA (4) RAWDATA (5) RAWDATA (6) RAWDATA (7) RAWDATA (8) RAWDATA (9) RAWDATA (10) RAWDATA (11) 52 CCD OUT 14 DVDD2 VH (+15V) 1 D9 10 11 DRVDD P5V Q1071 BUFFER 7 VDC IC1070 ICX089AK CCD V1 16 VH VH (+15V) 6 VL CCD VH 15V SUB 10 2 CLKO 17 CS 62 CLR 19 VCTRL 18 HD IN 16 VD IN 15 DSP CLK AGC CS TG RST VGATE XTGHD XTGVD 37 DVDD2 PWM ZA 48 AVDD PWM ZB SDATA 63 50 AVDD Z PSB CAM 3V 59 DVDD1 SCK 64 F PSB DA LOAD IRIS CL IRIS OP I SW P GY OUT Y GY OUT P GYRO EVF 8.5V LCD 3V 29 29 20 20 CAM 3V 15 15 30 30 21 21 10 10 P5V 46 46 9 9 IRIS 3V 45 45 8 8 Y GYRO Q1506 CN1002 XSG P5V P5V LCD 3V CAM 3V CAM 3V IRIS 3V CCD 15V CCD −7V RAWDATA (2) RAWDATA (3) RAWDATA (4) RAWDATA (5) RAWDATA (6) RAWDATA (7) RAWDATA (8) RAWDATA (9) RAWDATA (10) RAWDATA (11) DSP CLK AGC CS TG RST VGATE XTGHD XTGVD PWM FA PWM FB PWM ZA PWM ZB Z PSB F PSB CAM SO CAM SCK DA LOAD IRIS CL IRIS OP I SW P GY OUT Y GY OUT P GYRO Y GYRO I ENC Z RES SW TEMP F RES SW LED RET CSYNC VF B VF G VF R LCD EEP SOUT LCD EEP SCK EVF SEN EVF EEP CS EVF EEP SIN EVF BL ON EVF 8.5V EVF 3V ON B19 A19 A20 A29 B20 B21 B22 B23 B24 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B10 B12 B15 B16 B17 B18 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 B13 B14 B25 B34 B35 B27 B28 B29 B31 B32 B33 A14 B30 A15 B26 A25 A23 A22 A21 A31 A33 A32 A30 A34 A27 A28 A35 CN1502 PANEL R PANEL G PANEL B EVF EEP SIN LCD EEP SCK LCD EEP SOUT C SYNC 5 6 7 3 2 1 4 TO CAMERA SECTION-2 MAIN P.C.B. CN1101 TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. CN1101 Q1505 I ENC CVF P.C.B. Q4101 LCD (CVF) 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 6 5 4 2 1 CN4102 COM CKV1 CKV2 STV XSTV XENB ENB VBB DSD XDSG DSG B R G VDD CKH2 CKH1 STH XSTH Q4102 CN4101 BL5V COM CKV1 CKV2 STV XSTV XENB ENB VBB DSD XDSG DSG B R G VDD CKH2 CKH1 STH XSTH XSTH 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 14 15 16 17 18 20 21 22 23 1 2 3 5 7 8 9 11 12 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 13 6 14 22 23 CN1501 XSTH STH CKH1 CKH2 G R B DSG XDSG ENB XENB XSTV STV CKV2 CKV1 COM DSD VDD VBB BL5V BL5V XSTH STH CKH1 CKH2 G R B DSG XDSG ENB XENB XSTV EVF 8.5V STV CKV2 CKV1 Q1509 Q1507 COM DSD EVF 8.5V 01 Feb. 2003 17 XSTH 18 STH RIN 53 20 CKH 1 Q1504 Q1502 19 CKH 2 43 GOUT GIN 54 45 ROUT BIN 55 40 BOUT Q1503 24 DSG 23 XDSG 30 ENB 29 XENB 25 XSTV 26 STV IC1501 LV4141W EVF DRIVER Q1501 HDIN 60 DATA 7 SCLK 8 LOAD 6 TO HINGE ASS'Y 27 CKV2 28 CKV1 38 COMOUT VCC 1 49 EVF A3V SYNC IN 57 50 DSDOUT VDD 1 39 VCCCOM VDD 2 11 47 VCC 2 VDD 0 12 1 LCD 3V 2 SK 3 DI 8 VCC IC1502 BR9020FFV-W EEPROM CS 1 DO 4 C CANON INC. 2003 CAMERA SECTION-2 DIGITAL VIDEO SIGNAL ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A DIGITAL AUDIO SIGNAL TO CAMERA SECTION-1 CAC P.C.B. CN1002 A19 A20 A29 B20 B21 B22 B23 B24 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B10 B16 B17 B18 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A21 A23 A22 A25 B12 B13 B14 B15 B19 B25 B26 B27 B28 B29 B30 B31 B32 B33 B34 B35 CN1101 P5V P5V LCD 3V CAM 3V CAM 3V IRIS 3V CCD 15V CCD −7V RAWDATA (2) RAWDATA (3) RAWDATA (4) RAWDATA (5) RAWDATA (6) RAWDATA (7) RAWDATA (8) RAWDATA (9) RAWDATA (10) RAWDATA (11) DSP CLK VGATE XTGHD XTGVD PWM FA PWM FB PWM ZA PWM ZB Z PSB F PSB Z RES SW F RES SW VF R VF B VF G CSYNC AGC CS CAM SO CAM SCK TG RST XSG DA LOAD LED RET I SW P GY OUT Y GY OUT TEMP P GYRO Y GYRO I ENC IRIS CL IRIS OP A9 A10/AP BA0 BA1 152 MDATA L1 DQ2 5 MDATA L(2) 230 MDATA L2 DQ3 7 MDATA L(3) 151 MDATA L3 DQ4 8 MDATA L(4) 300 MDATA L4 DQ5 10 MDATA L(5) 64 MDATA L5 DQ6 11 MDATA L(6) 229 MDATA L6 DQ7 13 MDATA L(7) 150 MDATA L7 DQ8 74 MDATA L(8) 299 MDATA L8 DQ9 76 MDATA L(9) 228 MDATA L9 DQ10 77 MDATA L(10) 149 MDATA L10 DQ11 79 MDATA L(11) 62 MDATA L11 DQ12 80 MDATA L(12) 298 MDATA L12 DQ13 82 MDATA L(13) 227 MDATA L13 DQ14 83 MDATA L(14) 61 MDATA L14 DQ15 85 MDATA L(15) 297 MDATA L15 DQ16 31 MDATA L(16) 226 MDATA L16 DQ17 33 MDATA L(17) 147 MDATA L17 DQ18 34 MDATA L(18) 60 MDATA L18 DQ19 36 MDATA L(19) 59 MDATA L19 DQ20 37 MDATA L(20) 146 MDATA L20 DQ21 39 MDATA L(21) 58 MDATA L21 DQ22 40 MDATA L(22) 145 MDATA L22 DQ23 42 MDATA L(23) 295 MDATA L23 DQ24 45 MDATA L(24) 224 MDATA L24 DQ25 47 MDATA L(25) 57 MDATA L25 DQ26 48 MDATA L(26) 223 MDATA L26 DQ27 50 MDATA L(27) 294 MDATA L27 DQ28 51 MDATA L(28) 56 MDATA L28 DQ29 53 MDATA L(29) 143 MDATA L29 DQ30 54 MDATA L(30) 222 MDATA L30 DQ31 56 MDATA L(31) 55 MDATA L31 96 RAWDATA 2 111 PWM2 TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-2 IC2301 266 PWM1 194 PWM0 10 CDATA4 101 CDATA5 271 ICS0 199 ICS1 Q2302 312 VF R2 175 VF B2 Q2301 91 VF G2 69 CSYNC0 324 SCS4 13 SO3 IC2301(1/3) MB87M1255 VIC3 100 318 183 99 317 01 Feb. 2003 7 BDATA 7 BDATA 6 BDATA 5 BDATA 4 BDATA 3 11 CDATA1 EADDR M12 288 EADDR M13 216 EADDR M14 135 EADDR M15 215 EADDR M16 287 EADDR M17 47 EADDR M18 46 EADDR M19 134 EADDR M20 214 EADDR M22 213 EDATA M0 285 EDATA M1 44 EDATA M2 132 EDATA M3 43 EDATA M5 131 EDATA M6 42 EDATA M7 211 EDATA M8 130 179 RAWDATA 5 EDATA M11 210 RAWDATA 6 EDATA M12 40 94 RAWDATA 7 EDATA M13 282 254 RAWDATA 8 EDATA M14 209 178 RAWDATA 9 EDATA M15 128 RAWDATA 10 BDATA 0 202 93 RAWDATA 11 BDATA 1 31 6 TGCLK BDATA 2 275 7 TG HD BDATA 3 201 182 TG VD BDATA 4 30 VGATE BDATA 5 119 BDATA 7 200 ADATA 0 116 WCK 149 WCLK 112 WCLK ADATA 1 271 RDY 46 RDY 142 RDY ADATA 2 197 LREQ 348 XEINT1 221 XEINT1 ADATA 3 25 XEINT0 283 XEINT0 54 XEINT0 ADATA 4 270 XECS5 211 XECS M 141 XECS M ADATA 5 24 XEWRL 281 XEWRL M 292 XEWRL M ADATA 6 23 EDREQ 133 DREQ0 281 DREQ0 ADATA 7 113 EDACK 282 XDACK0 127 XDACK0 MCCLK A 14 CARD SCK SI3 105 XRESET 22 XRESET MCDT A3 105 CARD DAT3 184 TDI MCDT A2 188 CARD DAT2 276 BDATACLK MCDT A1 263 CARD DAT1 TDO 113 TDI CCLK 103 BDATA CLK 6 TO CAMERA SECTION-1 CAC P.C.B. CN1002 EDATA M4 212 IC1102 MB87M1285PBT MACS EDATA M9 283 8 AUD2 I MACS I EADDR M0 toM22 EDATA M0 to M15 XEWRU XERD TRST TMS 27M EADDR M21 133 194 LRCLK ADATA 6 BDATA 2 186 CDATA0 EADDR M11 136 LRCLK ADATA 5 95 217 AIN6 EADDR M9 137 EADDR M10 49 LRCK 62 ADATA 4 255 BDATA 1 18 30 EADDR M8 217 BDATA 6 274 ADATA 3 179 340 AIN5 EADDR M7 289 21 AUDO1 ADATA 2 314 BDATA 0 TO JACK P.C.B. SECTION JACK P.C.B. CN7 CN2101 P GY OUT Y GY OUT EADDR M6 51 AUDO1 ADATA 1 315 50 AIN4 EADDR M5 218 AUD1 O 148 ADATA 0 137 AIN8 EADDR M4 290 111 AUDI2 292 C LKON 319 CDATA2 EADDR M3 139 AUDI2 12 SCLK3 185 CDATA3 EADDR M2 52 AUD1 I 227 346 D7 263 SCS8 EADDR M1 219 EDATA M10 41 2 AMCK 228 AUDI1 20 EADDR M0 291 255 RAWDATA 4 3 21 PWM3 AUDO2 258 RAWDATA 3 4 TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MDQM L0 A8 MDATA L(1) MDQM L1 A7 4 MDQM L2 A6 DQ1 MDQM L3 A5 CAM 3V IRIS 3V CCD 15V CCD−7V 301 MDATA L0 MCLK L A4 LCD 3V MDATA L(0) MCKE L A3 P 5V 2 XMCS L A2 IC1101 HY57V643220CT-55 SDRAM DQ0 XMRAS L 23 XMWE L 22 XMCAS L 24 MADDR L12 66 MADDR L11 MADDR L(12) 65 MADDR L9 MADDR L(11) 64 MADDR L10 MADDR L(9) MADDR L(10) 63 MADDR L8 MADDR L(8) 62 MADDR L7 MADDR L(7) 61 MADDR L6 MADDR L(6) 60 MADDR L5 MADDR L(5) 27 MADDR L4 MADDR L(4) 26 MADDR L3 MADDR L(3) 25 MADDR L2 MADDR L(2) 16 MADDR L1 MADDR L(1) 71 156 234 304 69 155 233 303 68 154 67 153 66 231 71 235 305 158 236 306 73 159 74 237 MADDR L0 MADDR L(0) /CS CLK 28 A1 /RAS 59 A0 /WE 67 DQM0 68 DQM1 20 DQM2 19 CKE 18 DQM3 17 /CAS MAIN P.C.B.(1/6) MCDT A0 15 CARD DAT MCCMD A 189 CARD CMD CARD SCK CARD DAT3 CARD DAT2 CARD DAT1 CARD DAT CARD CMD TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. XEWRU M 220 XERD M 53 TRST 185 TMS 9 VCLK 121 TCK 101 3 ADATA 7 178 316 182 C CANON INC. 2003 SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A MAIN P.C.B.(2/6) CK 3V 2 VBAT 3 13 VIN 14 VRO 5 SW 7 VDC IC102 BD4187FV BACKUP D100 CS LI 3V 4 70 18 E3DET Q100 SWOUT DVDD 3V 25 LI3V DETECT 69 START/STOP SWITCH LIDET 68 HARF PHOTO SWITCH E3V RESET MICOM UNREG 12 VOUT PHOTO SWITCH 11 E3V+LI3V 6 VTR POWER SWITCH 76 CAM POWER SWITCH 77 T/XC PW SW 78 FCHO/DEBUGO 36 DVDD3V E3V+LI3V EPM 39 72 CH DET CE 44 CNVSS 7 FLASH CLK 31 FLASH RTS 32 FLASH RXD1 30 FLASH TXD1 29 IC103 BD4746G RESET VCC 5 VTR UNREG MODE RESET 10 VOUT 4 RMC PULSE IN 16 73 UNREG DET Q101 Q104 11 XOUT X101 16MHz XRESET 49 S DET 79 EJECT SWITCH 66 8 XCIN LET CONT 80 WIDE CONT 81 LINE IN 82 9 XCOUT VCO HI 54 VTOS EN 17 VIC3 CS 48 TO POWER SUPPLY SECTION MAIN P.C.B. 52 VTR POWER SWITCH VTR ON DC J DET A/D I A/D V INIT-CHG1 INIT-CHG2 CHAGE BATT INFO AD EVF 8.5V ON BATT E3 INIT-CHG1 INIT-CHG2 VIC3 CLOCK 35 71 DC J DET VIC3 TO SUBCOM DATA 34 90 A/D I SUBCOM TO VIC3 DATA 33 89 A/D V STOV PC 2 99 PS VTOS PC 1 100 TRI 41 CHAGE IC100 M30620MCN MODE MI-COM. 88 BATT INFO A/D VTOS ACTIVE 24 MTOC MODE2 59 MTOC MODE1 58 MTOC MODE0 57 E3V 96 VREF E3V+LI3V 97 AVCC NTSC XPAL 40 CASSETTE IN SWITCH 67 TO HINGE ASS'Y 1 2 3 4 5 8 9 10 11 12 CN990 LCD 3V LCD 5V LCD 8.5V LCD 15V LCD −10V VTR UNREG PANEL XOE PANEL LCK LCD CS LCD EEP CS LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD VTR CASSETTE MEMORY A/D0 84 3V 5V 8.5V 15V −10V UNREG 60 VCC2 CASSETTE MEMORY A/D1 85 14 VCC1 CASSETTE MEMORY SDA 28 CASSETTE MEMORY A/D2 86 38 PANEL BL ON CASSETTE MEMORY SDL 27 46 PANEL UD CASSETTE MEMORY ON 26 63 PANEL LR 61 LCD ON 1 4 5 8 6 9 10 2 CN102 DVDD3V E3V+LI3V EPM CE CNVSS FLASH CLK FLASH RST FLASH RXD1 FLASH TXD1 MODE RESET DEBCLK DEBUD DEBDD XDEBEN CG CS EEP/CG CLK EEP/CG SO DOT CLK OSD I0 OSD I1 VIC HD VIC VD B7 A15 A2 A3 A4 B2 B3 B4 B5 A1 A6 A8 A10 A12 B8 B9 B10 B11 B12 B13 B14 B15 CHAGE LED 50 PANEL BOTTOM/TOP SWITCH 65 TO OPERATION KEY UNIT N.C TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-2 MAIN P.C.B. VIC VD VIC HD OSD I1 OSD I0 DOT CLK EEP/CG SO EEP/CG CLK CGCS XDEBEN DEBDD DEBUD DEBCLK ZOOM KEY VTR POW SW CAM POW SW T/C POW SW FCH O MODE RESET RMC IN XRESET S DET EJECT SW LET CONT WIDE CONT LINE IN VCO HI VTOS EN VTOS CS VTOS SCK VTOS DATA STOV DATA STOV PC VTOS PC VTOS ACTIVE STOV MODE2 STOV MODE1 STOV MODE0 NTSC XPAL CAS IN MIC 1 MIC 2 MIC 3 MIC ON CARD DET CARD PRO CARD ACC LED 13 XIN X100 32.768KHz CN101 CK 3V PHOTO SW HALF PHOTO SW START/STOP SW TAPE/CARD SW VTR PW SW CAM PW SW ZOOM AD RKEY P.C.B. TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MAIN P.C.B. TO RKEY BACKLIGHT ASS'Y CN100 P5V KEY LED2 KEY LED1 KEY LED0 1 4 3 2 OSDC/EEPROM/EVFIC/LCDIC/SCK 3 OSDC/EEPROM/EVFIC/LCDIC/SO 19 EVF SEN FF CN103 PANEL OPEN SW TO DSW2 P.C.B. TO HINGE ASS'Y 2 TO SERVO SECTION MAIN P.C.B. CN101 PANEL B/T SW CARD P.C.B. 55 EVF 3V ON TO CAC P.C.B. CN1002 A34 A33 A31 A32 A35 A27 A30 A28 56 EVF BL ON CN1101 EVF EEP SIN LCD EEP SCK LCD EEP SOUT EVF SEN EVF 3V ON EVF BL ON EVF EEP CS EVF 8.5V LITHIUM BATTERY DIAL CCW SWITCH 43 KEY AD2 93 KEY AD3 95 45 EVF EEPROM CS Q103 KEY LED2 21 KEY LED1 22 20 EVF 8.5V ON Q990 Q991 KEY LED0 23 Q102 TO CAMERA SECTION-2 MAIN P.C.B. 01 CARD DAT1 CARD DAT CARD SCK CARD DAT3 CARD CMD CARD DAT2 Feb. 2003 12 17 19 7 18 20 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 30 31 32 33 2 3 4 9 13 15 SW4001 SW4002 DE SEL CARD MIX SW4000 SW4003 DE ON/OFF SELF CN102 REW KEY KEY AD2 P5V KEY LED2 KEY LED1 KEY LED0 PANEL OPEN SW PANEL B/T SW 1 2 6 3 4 5 7 8 ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A DM-MV650i E DM-MV630i E DM-FV40 ONLY BT400 LI 3V PANEL OPEN SWITCH 64 CN100 CARD ACC LED CARD PRO CARD DET CHAGE LED PANEL B/T SW KEY AD0 KEY AD1 PAE/GREEN PANEL OPEN SW DIAL CW DIAL CCW KEY AD2 KEY AD3 KEY LED2 KEY LED1 KEY LED0 KEY LED0 CARD DAT2 CARD CMD CARD DAT3 CARD SCK CARD DAT CARD DAT1 P5V PLAY BT401 PAE/GREEN SW 75 DIAL CW SWITCH 42 REW SW102 KEY AD1 92 LCD EEP SIN 5 SW103 STOP SW101 KEY AD0 91 4 SW100 P5V 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 15 10 13 11 21 26 14 16 18 20 24 27 29 30 31 CN4001 KEY LED0 KEY LED1 KEY LED2 KEY AD3 KEY AD2 DIAL CCW DIAL CW PANEL OPEN SW PANEL B/T SW PAE/GREEN KEY AD0 KEY AD1 CARD ACC LED CHAGE LED CARD DET CARD PRO CARD DAT1 CARD DAT CARD SCK DVDD 3V CARD DAT3 CARD CMD CARD DAT2 SW4004 GREEN P AE Q4000 4 VTR UNREG LED4000 P5V 3 2 6 1 5 CN4002 REW KEY DIAL PUSH MENU KEY AD2 KEY LED2 KEY LED1 KEY LED0 PANEL OPEN SW PANEL B/T SW DIAL CCW DIAL CW P5V 14 5 1 13 12 11 10 8 7 4 3 9 CN4000 CARD DET CARD PRO MMC DAT2 MMC DAT1 MMC DAT MMC CLK MMC VDD MMC CMD MMC RSV 12 10 9 8 7 5 4 2 1 C SD CARD ZR70 MC A ZR65 MC A DM-MV650i E DM-MV630i E DM-FV40 ONLY CANON INC. 2003 SERVO SECTION ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A DRUM SERVO SIGNAL CAPSTAN SERVO SIGNAL DMC III MAIN P.C.B. (3/6) D.W 37 D.V 35 D.U 34 D.COM 33 TO POWER SUPPLY SECTION MAIN P.C.B D D C C VM VS VM VS D VM 28 D.VM D.PGIN− 20 D VS 29 D.VS D.FGPGIN+ 19 60 C.VM D.FGIN− 18 61 C.VS C VS C.HW− 12 CFG 15 C.FGSMT C.HW+ 11 DPG 16 D.PGSMT C.HU+ 10 DFG 21 D.FGSMT C.HU− 9 30 D.EC C.HV+ 8 C.HV− 7 40 L.FRB 41 L.REF IC301 BD6636KV MOTOR DRIVE C.FGIN− 14 Q304 57 D.PS C.FGIN+ 13 DVDD 3V TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MAIN P.C.B TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B CFG DPG DFG DERR LOAD FR LODE ON DRUM ON CAP ON CAP FWD CERR T REEL FG S REEL FG DA CFG DEW MSW AD TAPE TOP TAPE END TAPE LED REC PROOF REEL LED CONT DA TREEL DA SREEL MIC2 MIC3 C.U 2 59 C.FBR C.V 3 62 C.EC C.W 5 27 UNREG L.REV 44 DVDD 3V 22 VCC L.FWD 42 P 5V 45 L.VM R.IN1+ 46 VTR UNREG TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-3 MAIN P.C.B 58 C.PS R.IN2+ 49 51 ROUT2 R.IN2− 50 Feb. 2003 CN302 C H− W− W+ C H+ U+ U− V+ V− CFG2 CFG1 U COIL U COIL W COIL W COIL V COIL V COIL CFG VCC 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 18 1 2 3 4 5 6 17 DRUM MOTOR PG FG CAPSTAN MOTOR FG LOADING MOTOR DVDD 3V CN301 LOAD (−) LOAD (−) LOAD (+) LOAD (+) DEW+ MSW SENS MSW VCC MSW VSS 4 5 9 10 3 6 7 8 MODE SW TAPE END SENSOR BOT DET EOT DET DVDD 3V Q303 Q303 Q302 Q301 P 5V Q300 Q305 CAS IN MIC1 MIC2 MIC3 MIC ON IC300 NJM12904R OPE AMP 01 1 2 8 9 10 11 3 6 7 5 DEW SENSOR R.IN1− 47 48 ROUT1 CN300 W W V V U U COIL COM DPG DFG SENS COM IN+1 3 OUT 1 1 IN−1 2 OUT 2 7 IN−2 6 IN+2 5 DVDD 3V CN303 BOT E BOT C EOT E EOT C LED A LED K REC PRF MIC3 MIC2 MIC1 C IN T IN− T IN+ T OUT− T OUT+ S IN− S IN+ S OUT− S OUT+ TAPE TOP SENSOR 1 2 20 21 14 15 5 4 6 7 12 8 10 9 11 16 18 17 19 SAFETY SW MIC CASSETTE IN SW FG TAKE UP REEL FG SUPPLY REEL C CANON INC. 2003 AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 ANALOG VIDEO SIGNAL ANALOG AUDIO SIGNAL DIGITAL AUDIO SIGNAL CARD USB/SIC SIGNAL MAIN P.C.B. (4/6) NTSC iPAL ONLY CN2101 CLAMP 48 EQ Y LINE IN 75Ω 75Ω Q2104 Y IN CLAMP Y REC C 34 30 17 Y OUT C OUT TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-2 VIC VD C OUT SERIAL DATA 25 WIDE DETECT CLK DATA 15 CS VIC VD VCC Q2100 VIF 4.7V 7 11 20 26 31 32 37 45 47 12 13 14 19 VIF 4.7V AV SCLK AV SO VIF CS Q2106 Q2102 EXT DETECT 233 364 298 248 257 154 CSYNC I ADV MIC L ADV MIC R SHOE ID1 SHOE ON VCLK C CONT 27 Y OUT Q3501 CLAMP 10 CSYNC I Y IN TO POWER SUPPLY SECTION MAIN P.C.B. 40 21 Q701 ZR70 MC A DM-MV650i E DM-FV40 ONLY 36 BPF V OUT Q2105 RMC IN EJECT SW S DET LET CONT WIDE CONT LINE IN X RESET LPF Y/C SEP AA 4.7V ZR70 MC A DM-MV650i E DM-FV40 ONLY 4 Y CONT Q2101 C LINE IN Q3503 CLAMP 46 75Ω Q2103 2 27MHz GCA AVDD 1.4V TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. C SYNC SEP VCLK V I/O/H/P R Y I/O C I/O AV L/HP L AV R D− D+ V BUS CAM LED AV DET EXT PDET EXT R EXT L SP − SP + S DET EJECT SW RMC IN IC2100 LD502U VIF2 C IN 11 34 37 15 14 26 27 23 8 12 3 4 2 22 21 33 31 19 V LINE IN CLAMP Y TO JACK P.C.B. CN7 VIC VD DATA COMMUNICATION ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A SCLK2 261 TO SERVO SECTION MAIN P.C.B. 267 TMS 112 TCK AA3V AA4.7V 28 42 85 C O FROM AUDIO VIDEO SECTION-2 IC2301 (3/3) 88 VRL 2 MIC2 MIC3 10 14 13 39 41 20 58 30 GAIN AMP LINE AMP DAC CONTROL REGISTER 34 AIF CS 35 AV SO 33 HP AMP 205 34 275 123 332 204 33 122 32 203 121 331 31 273 202 120 330 DN Q3502 AV SCLK VBUS CAM LED 15 SCS9 338 XECS4 16 SCS5 107 SCS6 36 9 CDATA7 339 AIN 14 EADDR (0) 279 EADDR (0) E1 A0 129 EADDR (1) D1 210 EADDR (2) C1 DO0 E2 EDATA (0) 40 EADDR (3) A1 H2 EDATA (1) 337 EADDR (4) B1 E3 EDATA (2) 39 EADDR (5) D2 H3 EDATA (3) 128 EADDR (6) C2 H4 EDATA (4) 209 EADDR (7) A2 E4 EDATA (5) 38 EADDR (8) B5 H5 EDATA (6) 336 EADDR (9) A5 E5 EDATA (7) 127 EADDR (10) C5 F2 EDATA (8) 208 EADDR (11) D5 G2 EDATA (9) 37 EADDR (12) B6 F3 EDATA (10) 277 EADDR (13) A6 G3 EDATA (11) 126 EADDR (14) C6 F4 EDATA (12) 335 EADDR (15) D6 G5 EDATA (13) 334 EADDR (16) E6 F5 EDATA (14) 36 EADDR (17) B2 DO15 G6 EDATA (15) 125 EADDR (18) C3 206 EADDR (19) D4 A19 276 EADDR (20) D3 NC3 27 ICD0 IC801 AK4561 AUDIO INTERFACE CR NETWORK 64 1 CR NETWORK 2 3 4 6 7 40 54 53 PRE AMP INV AMP EQ AMP HPF 50 (R) 49 48 47 46 CR NETWORK 44 43 38 31 147 LPS 32 280 XECS2 24 AMCK 22 WCK 23 LRCK 20 PWM4 LINE MIC 60 AD OFF REC MUTE CLOCK DIVIDER MIC 61 CN701 INT MIC R INT MIC L ALC AMP ADC AUDIO I/F CONTROL 25 FORM CAMERA SECTION 26 LINE IC2301 (2/3) MB87M1254 VIC3 CR NETWORK Q810,Q811 POWER OFF MUTE OFF MUTE Q802 Q806 AUDIO MUTE 131 XECS1 Q812 Q804 Q808 4 5 HP ON HP MUTE 8 P 5V 5 V IN V OUT 4 6 IC802 NJM2770R SP DRIVER 4V Vcc 1 IC803 TK11140CS 4V REGULATOR 291 D5 225 D4 Q807 V REF Feb. 2003 AIF CS 329 DP D+ 11 AUDIO MUTE 01 SCS2 191 136 AIN13 D− HP AMP 12 MIC VIF CS 249 VRH 2 15 16 2 4 AV SO SCS3 17 EDATA (15) 250 Y O POWER SUPPLY SECTION MAIN P.C.B. VTR ON 9 (L) AV SCLK SO2 321 113 TDO EDATA (0) N.C CN2900 B8 TMS A7 TCK B10 TDO A1 V I/O B7 TRST B5 MIC2 B6 MIC3 B3 VTR ON IC3201 Q805 35 XERD 43 XEWRU 44 Q801 SP STANDBY F1 CE EADDR (22) 333 XECSO 212 Q803 IC2300 MBM29LV160BE7OPBT FLASH G1 OE A4 WE 27M TCK TMS EADATA (0) to (15) EADDR (0) to (22) XERD XEWRU TRST AUD 2 I MACS1 I B4 RESET TRST 23 146 D3 XRESET 135 C TO CAMERA SECTION-2 MAIN P.C.B. CANON INC. 2003 AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-2 DIGITAL DV SIGNAL ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A DRUM SERVO SIGNAL DIGITAL (VIDEO+AUDIO SIGNAL) CAPSTAN SERVO SIGNAL MAIN P.C.B. (5/6) DQ14 51 DQ15 53 A0 23 A1 24 IC2302 W986416DH-7 SDRAM A2 25 A3 26 A4 29 A5 30 A6 31 A7 32 A8 33 A9 34 A10/AP 22 A11 35 A12(BA1) 21 A13(BA0) 20 DQML 15 /WE 16 /CAS 17 /RAS 18 /CS 19 CKE 37 CLK 38 DQMU 39 355 MDATA (9) MDATA (10) D0 226 75 MDATA (11) MDATA (12) D1 347 302 MDATA (12) MDATA (13) D2 59 238 MDATA (13) MDATA (14) CTL0 145 160 MDATA (14) MDATA (15) CTL1 224 74 MDATA (15) ADDR (0) SYSCLK 57 82 ADDR (0) ADDR (1) AIN7 285 167 ADDR (1) ADDR (2) AIN10 216 244 ADDR (2) ADDR (3) XEINT2 214 306 ADDR (3) ADDR (4) ICD1 198 81 ADDR (4) ADDR (5) SCS0 264 359 ADDR (5) ADDR (6) UAT CLK 192 243 ADDR (6) ADDR (7) TX 325 80 ADDR (7) ADDR (8) RX 19 305 ADDR (8) ADDR (9) XDEBEN 272 165 ADDR (9) ADDR (10) 242 ADDR (11) ADDR (12) ADDR (13) DEBCLK 28 ICS2 117 304 ADDR (13) DQML SO1 188 360 DQML XWE SCLK1 187 83 XWE XCAS SCLK0 104 169 XCAS XRAS SO0 322 OSD I0 OSD I1 DOT CLK STOV MODE0 STOV MODE1 STOV MODE2 STOV PC CG CS VTOS CS ZOOM KEY CARD DET CARD PRO CARD ACCESS LED VTOS EN VTOS SCK VTOS DATA STOV DATA XDEBEN DEBUD DEBDD DEBCLK NTSC XPAL EEP/CG SO EEP/CG CLK VTOS ACTIVE VTOS PC 246 XRAS XCS 362 XCS CKE 307 CKE MCLK REC H 63 HA 3V HA 4.7V 5 38 CN2900 VTR POW SW T/C POW SW CAM POW SW FCH 0 SWP PBRF A3 A4 A5 A6 A8 A10 CN2000 H1A H1B H2A H2B 2 3 5 6 NC 168 MCLK DQMU 361 DQMU DRUM ON REC PROOF REEL LED CONT DA CFG DA SREEL DA TREEL TAPE TOP TAPE END MSW AD DEW CAS IN T REEL FG S REEL FG DERR CERR CFG DPG DFG CAP FWD TAPE LED 36 26 ICLK UTIL SWP 5 252 32 RDAT 150 35 116 ICD3 REC CONT 21 IC2000 LD502WA VRP2 REC ON 46 270 ICD2 45 213 BRQ 268 TCLK 43 45 BGRNTX 34 XRDAT 294 42 265 PWM7 H1A H1B H2A H2B CH-1 HEAD CH-2 HEAD DRUM UNIT 40 110 PWM6 193 PWM5 39 341 AIN0 SDLSEL 350 9 286 AIN1 PB H 229 218 AIN2 1 SDL PB ON Q2000 138 AIN3 6 48 AIN12 68 RFGT 232 RFGS SWP 65 2 PBRF 158 17 VIDEO SIGNAL TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION–1 IC2301 (2/3) 296 PWMD 153 PWMC AUDIO SIGNAL 67 CFG VCA TO CAMERA SECTION–2 IC2301 (1/3) 66 DPG GOH GDL EQ VCO 231 DFG 152 ROFS 58 D6 EQFC RAGC RAPC RAFC RCLK XRCLK 230 151 176 353 295 93 Feb. 2003 DEBDD 200 164 ADDR (12) CAP ON 01 DEBUD 118 IC2301(3/3) MB87M1255 VIC3 358 ADDR (10) ADDR (11) LOAD ON LOAD FR LOAD ON CAP ON DRUM ON REC PROOF REEL LED CONT DA CFG DA SREEL DA TREEL TAPE TOP TAPE END MSW AD DEW CAS IN T REEL FG S REEL FG DERR CERR CFG DPG DFG CAP FWD TAPE LED DOT CLK 156 161 MDATA (10) MDATA (11) LOAD FR TO SERVO SECTION MAIN P.C.B. OSD I1 70 1 177 313 29 30 13 11 12 8 25 26 28 22 23 XRCLK DQ13 50 OSD I0 234 356 MDATA (8) MDATA (9) RCLK DQ12 48 76 MDATA (7) MDATA (8) TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. VIC VD VIC HD OSD I0 OSD I1 DOT CLK STOV MODE0 STOV MODE1 STOV MODE2 STOV PC CG CS VTOS CS ZOOM KEY CARD DET CARD PRO CARD ACCESS LED VTOS EN VTOS SCK VTOS DATA STOV DATA XDEBEN DEBUD DEBDD DEBCLK NTSC XPAL EEP/CG SO EEP/CG CLK VTOS ACTIVE VTOS PC VCO HI VTR POW SW T/C POW SW CAM POW SW FCH 0 VIC HD EQFC DQ11 47 MDATA (7) HD 155 RAFC DQ10 45 VD 233 162 MDATA (6) VIC VD RAPC DQ9 44 MDATA (6) TO DV TERMINAL 1 2 3 4 TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 VIC VD 240 MDATA (5) RAGC DQ8 42 303 MDATA (4) MDATA (5) EQ CONT DQ7 13 49 VCCQ4 XTPB 141 GDL CONT DQ6 11 43 VCCQ3 TPB 53 357 MDATA (3) GDH CONT 27 VCC3 163 MDATA (2) UTIL SWP 1 8 DQ5 10 MDATA (4) XTPB TPB XTPA TPA UTIL SWP 0 DQ4 14 VCC2 MDATA (3) GDH CONT 7 GDL CONT 5 DQ3 XTPA 220 UTIL SWP 3 DQ2 241 MDATA (1) UTIL SWP 2 VCCQ2 MDATA (2) TPA 140 RAGC VCCQ1 9 4 78 MDATA (0) EQ CONT 3 DQ1 MDATA (1) UTIL SWP 4 VCC1 CN2501 MDATA (0) RAPC 1 2 RCLK DQ0 XRCLK SDRAM 2.7V C CANON INC. 2003 POWER SUPPLY SECTION DRUM SERVO SIGNAL ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A CAPSTAN SERVO SIGNAL MAIN P.C.B.(6/6) CN891 SHOE UNREG SHOE UNREG ID-1 ADV MIC L ADV MIC R Q3209 FU3205 TO DC P.C.B. DC JACK 2 3 1 CN3201 DC + DC J SW DC − Q3210 ZR70 MC A DM-MV650i E DM-FV40 ONLY FU3201 FU3202 Q1805 7 6 5 1 2 3 4 Q1804 6 5 4 1 Q1802 2 VTR UNREG OSC 46 3 CH1 Q3204 1.4V (CH1) 33 DC J DET INIT-CHG2 INIT-CHG1 CHAGE A/D I VTR ON EVF 8.5V ON A/D V BATT INFO AD BATTA E3 43 27 VCC Q1808 Q1807 2 1 4 50 3 5 CH2 53 MICOM UNREG CN3202 BATT E3 BATT INFO AD BATT − BATT − BATT + BATT + LPF MACS 1.4V LPF DVDD 1.4V LPF AVDD 1.4V LPF HA 3V LPF IRIS 3V LPF LCD 3V LPF CAM 3V LPF AA 3V LPF DVDD 3V 40 D1802 1 2 3 4 5 6 TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. C VS D VS FU3204 34 TO BATTERY TERMIANL TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MAIN P.C.B. ADV MIC R ADV MIC L SHOE ID1 SHOE ON Q1806 D1801 TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. TO SHOE CONNECTOR ASS'Y FU3203 Q1803 8 1 2 5 8 9 Q3205 3V (CH3) CH3 2 1 4 56 5 D1803 3 FU1801 3 IC3201 MB3881 DC/DC CONVERTER 1 2 5 Q3206 P5V (CH4) 7 6 4 IC3204 TK11125CS V OUT 2.5V REGULATOR 4 IC3203 TK11147CS V OUT 4.7V REGULATOR 4 5 V IN IC1802 MM6564XF OPE/AMP AVDD 2.7V LPF SDRAM 2.7V LPF DIF 2.7V 5 V IN 2 1 DVDD 2.5V 4 57 LPF 5 37 CH4 IC3202 TK11128CS V OUT 2.7V REGULATOR V IN 3 LPF AA 4.7V LPF VIF 4.7V LPF HA 4.7V LPF LCD 5V 5 P 5V 21 Q3207 DRUM VS (CH5) CH5 22 2 TO SYSTEM CONTROL SECTION MAIN P.C.B. D VM C VS 1 4 60 3 5 15 Q3208 CAP VS (CH6) CH6 16 2 1 D3202 4 61 LPF 3 5 DVDD 3V 6 5 4 1 2 3 11 ON/OFF CONT. VTR ON TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MAIN P.C.B. 28 CH1,3,4,8 30 CH5,6 31 CH7 29 CH2 LCD 8.5V Q3200 CH7 T3201 Q3201 62 4 D3204 5 LPF LCD −10V LPF LCD 15V LPF CCD −7V LPF CCD 15V 3 5 2 7 CH8 64 D3201 8 1 Q3202 T3202 D3205 4 5 3 2 7 1 01 Feb. 2003 8 D3203 C CANON INC. 2003 LCD P.C.B. SECTION ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A DATA COMMUNICATION LCD P.C.B. LCD UNREG 5 1 ON T4201 CPU9D25 VTR UNREG 4 CONTROL Q4201 SWITCH 4 7 3 3 Q902 LCD 8.5V 6 5 1 4 2 2 IC4201 R1223N152H DC/DC CONVERTER CONTROL LCD 7.5V 3 1 3 2 Q4202 DRIVER 1 5 6 5 VTR UNREG 4 Q903 WP4201 Q4203 BACK LIGHT WP4202 LCD 3V Q912 TO HINGE ASS'Y LCD 15V 9 VTR UNREG SO CLK LCK OE 6 3V ON Q2 7 5V ON 25 Q904 2 DATA 3 CLK 4 LCK IC902 BU2092FV SERI/PARA CONVERTER Q5 10 2 R R OUT CLAMP GCA 15V ON 48 G CLAMP CNTRST GAMMA S/H G OUT BRIGHT GCA Q6 11 BL ON 1 B LCD 5V 5V ON Q4 LCD-10V OE LCK LCS ECS Q1 18 VCC3 Q901 20 LCD 8.5V VDD LCD 3V LCD 5V LCD 8.5V LCD 15V LCD -10V VTR UNREG PANEL XOE PANEL LCK LCD CS LCD EEP CS VCC2 CN902 1 2 3 4 5 8 9 10 11 12 7.5V Q911 LCD 3V LCD 5V B OUT CLAMP Q910 16 14 CN903 VGL VCC AVDD VR VG VB L/R STHR STHL CPH3 CPH2 CPH1 STVR STVL CKV DEV Q1H OEH VCOM VGH 11 GCA 19 OE 43 VDD E CS CLK SO SO 44 VCC1 1 CS 2 SK 3 DI 4 DO 3V ON IC901 BR9010RFV-W EEPROM RL Q906 STH2 VCC 8 LCD 3V STH1 LCD 3V CPH3 PLL 47 CPH2 CPH1 CN901 TO HINGE ASS'Y 5 6 7 4 1 2 3 PANEL R PANEL G PANEL B C SYNC LCD EEP SOUT LCD EEP SCK SIN 1 STV1 TIMING GENERATOR STV2 CPV SO CLK SO L CS CLK SO 37 38 39 OEV CS CLK D1 S I/F QH CONTROL IC903 AN2545NFHQ LCD DRIVE OEH COMDC VCOM 41 19 20 22 23 24 29 30 31 32 1 8 11 15 16 17 13 12 24 19 20 21 3 7 5 6 22 23 10 9 LCD UNIT LCD 33 LCD 15V 34 Q905 8 LCD 7.5V 15V ON 9 Q908 6 5 1 Q907 01 Feb. 2003 4 2 6 3 1 5 4 2 3 4 2 1 Q909 3 5 6 C CANON INC. 2003 JACK P.C.B. SECTION ANALOG VIDEO SIGNAL ZR70 MC A, ZR65 MC A, ZR60 A ANALOG AUDIO SIGNAL CARD USB/SIC SIGNAL JACK P.C.B. SPEAKER CN1 MIC JACK CN5 1 2 SP + SP − LED1 ZD1 CN7 TO AUDIO-VIDEO SECTION-1 MAIN P.C.B. CN2101 TO CAMERA SECTION-2 MAIN P.C.B. CN2101 18 17 31 37 36 35 25 27 28 24 16 13 12 20 8 6 5 2 21 9 SP + SP − CAM LED EXT L EXT P DET EXT R AV R AV DET V I/O/HP R AV L/HP L VBUS D− D+ RMC IN EJECT SW S DET Y I/O C I/O P GY OUT Y GY OUT AV JACK CN2 4 IC1601 ENC.03JA VCC P SENSOR GYRO OUT 1 CN3 VBUS (+5V) D− D+ 1 2 3 CN6 EJECT SW 2 USB JACK TO EJECT SW ZR70 MC A ZR65MC DM-MV650i E DM-MV630i E DM-FV40 ONLY CAM3V S JACK Y C G1 G2 CN4 4 01 Feb. 2003 IC1602 OUT ENC.03JB VCC Y SENSOR GYRO 1 CAM3V C CANON INC. 2003